PowerPC section flag tidy
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / bfd / elf32-ppc.c
1 /* PowerPC-specific support for 32-bit ELF
2 Copyright (C) 1994-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 Written by Ian Lance Taylor, Cygnus Support.
4
5 This file is part of BFD, the Binary File Descriptor library.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program; if not, write to the
19 Free Software Foundation, Inc., 51 Franklin Street - Fifth Floor,
20 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA. */
21
22
23 /* This file is based on a preliminary PowerPC ELF ABI. The
24 information may not match the final PowerPC ELF ABI. It includes
25 suggestions from the in-progress Embedded PowerPC ABI, and that
26 information may also not match. */
27
28 #include "sysdep.h"
29 #include <stdarg.h>
30 #include "bfd.h"
31 #include "bfdlink.h"
32 #include "libbfd.h"
33 #include "elf-bfd.h"
34 #include "elf/ppc.h"
35 #include "elf32-ppc.h"
36 #include "elf-vxworks.h"
37 #include "dwarf2.h"
38 #include "opcode/ppc.h"
39
40 typedef enum split16_format_type
41 {
42 split16a_type = 0,
43 split16d_type
44 }
45 split16_format_type;
46
47 /* RELA relocations are used here. */
48
49 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc
50 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
51 static bfd_reloc_status_type ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc
52 (bfd *, arelent *, asymbol *, void *, asection *, bfd *, char **);
53
54 /* Branch prediction bit for branch taken relocs. */
55 #define BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT 0x200000
56 /* Mask to set RA in memory instructions. */
57 #define RA_REGISTER_MASK 0x001f0000
58 /* Value to shift register by to insert RA. */
59 #define RA_REGISTER_SHIFT 16
60
61 /* The name of the dynamic interpreter. This is put in the .interp
62 section. */
63 #define ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER "/usr/lib/ld.so.1"
64
65 /* For old-style PLT. */
66 /* The number of single-slot PLT entries (the rest use two slots). */
67 #define PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES 8192
68
69 /* For new-style .glink and .plt. */
70 #define GLINK_PLTRESOLVE 16*4
71 #define GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE(htab, h) \
72 ((4*4 \
73 + (h != NULL \
74 && h == htab->tls_get_addr \
75 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt ? 8*4 : 0) \
76 + (1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align) - 1) \
77 & -(1u << htab->params->plt_stub_align))
78
79 /* VxWorks uses its own plt layout, filled in by the static linker. */
80
81 /* The standard VxWorks PLT entry. */
82 #define VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE 32
83 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry
84 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
85 {
86 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
87 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
88 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
89 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
90 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
91 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> */
92 0x60000000, /* nop */
93 0x60000000, /* nop */
94 };
95 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
96 [VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
97 {
98 0x3d9e0000, /* addis r12,r30,0 */
99 0x818c0000, /* lwz r12,0(r12) */
100 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
101 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
102 0x39600000, /* li r11,0 */
103 0x48000000, /* b 14 <.PLT0resolve+0x4> 14: R_PPC_REL24 .PLTresolve */
104 0x60000000, /* nop */
105 0x60000000, /* nop */
106 };
107
108 /* The initial VxWorks PLT entry. */
109 #define VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE 32
110 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry
111 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
112 {
113 0x3d800000, /* lis r12,0 */
114 0x398c0000, /* addi r12,r12,0 */
115 0x800c0008, /* lwz r0,8(r12) */
116 0x7c0903a6, /* mtctr r0 */
117 0x818c0004, /* lwz r12,4(r12) */
118 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
119 0x60000000, /* nop */
120 0x60000000, /* nop */
121 };
122 static const bfd_vma ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
123 [VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE / 4] =
124 {
125 0x819e0008, /* lwz r12,8(r30) */
126 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr r12 */
127 0x819e0004, /* lwz r12,4(r30) */
128 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
129 0x60000000, /* nop */
130 0x60000000, /* nop */
131 0x60000000, /* nop */
132 0x60000000, /* nop */
133 };
134
135 /* For executables, we have some additional relocations in
136 .rela.plt.unloaded, for the kernel loader. */
137
138 /* The number of non-JMP_SLOT relocations per PLT0 slot. */
139 #define VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS 3
140 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot. */
141 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS 2
142 /* The number of relocations in the PLTResolve slot when creating
143 a shared library. */
144 #define VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS_SHLIB 0
145
146 /* Some instructions. */
147 #define ADDIS_11_11 0x3d6b0000
148 #define ADDIS_11_30 0x3d7e0000
149 #define ADDIS_12_12 0x3d8c0000
150 #define ADDI_11_11 0x396b0000
151 #define ADD_0_11_11 0x7c0b5a14
152 #define ADD_3_12_2 0x7c6c1214
153 #define ADD_11_0_11 0x7d605a14
154 #define B 0x48000000
155 #define BA 0x48000002
156 #define BCL_20_31 0x429f0005
157 #define BCTR 0x4e800420
158 #define BEQLR 0x4d820020
159 #define CMPWI_11_0 0x2c0b0000
160 #define LIS_11 0x3d600000
161 #define LIS_12 0x3d800000
162 #define LWZU_0_12 0x840c0000
163 #define LWZ_0_12 0x800c0000
164 #define LWZ_11_3 0x81630000
165 #define LWZ_11_11 0x816b0000
166 #define LWZ_11_30 0x817e0000
167 #define LWZ_12_3 0x81830000
168 #define LWZ_12_12 0x818c0000
169 #define MR_0_3 0x7c601b78
170 #define MR_3_0 0x7c030378
171 #define MFLR_0 0x7c0802a6
172 #define MFLR_12 0x7d8802a6
173 #define MTCTR_0 0x7c0903a6
174 #define MTCTR_11 0x7d6903a6
175 #define MTLR_0 0x7c0803a6
176 #define NOP 0x60000000
177 #define SUB_11_11_12 0x7d6c5850
178
179 /* Offset of tp and dtp pointers from start of TLS block. */
180 #define TP_OFFSET 0x7000
181 #define DTP_OFFSET 0x8000
182
183 /* The value of a defined global symbol. */
184 #define SYM_VAL(SYM) \
185 ((SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_section->vma \
186 + (SYM)->root.u.def.section->output_offset \
187 + (SYM)->root.u.def.value)
188 \f
189 /* Relocation HOWTO's. */
190 /* Like other ELF RELA targets that don't apply multiple
191 field-altering relocations to the same localation, src_mask is
192 always zero and pcrel_offset is the same as pc_relative.
193 PowerPC can always use a zero bitpos, even when the field is not at
194 the LSB. For example, a REL24 could use rightshift=2, bisize=24
195 and bitpos=2 which matches the ABI description, or as we do here,
196 rightshift=0, bitsize=26 and bitpos=0. */
197 #define HOW(type, size, bitsize, mask, rightshift, pc_relative, \
198 complain, special_func) \
199 HOWTO (type, rightshift, size, bitsize, pc_relative, 0, \
200 complain_overflow_ ## complain, special_func, \
201 #type, FALSE, 0, mask, pc_relative)
202
203 static reloc_howto_type *ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_max];
204
205 static reloc_howto_type ppc_elf_howto_raw[] = {
206 /* This reloc does nothing. */
207 HOW (R_PPC_NONE, 3, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
208 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
209
210 /* A standard 32 bit relocation. */
211 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
212 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
213
214 /* An absolute 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
215 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
216 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
217 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
218
219 /* A standard 16 bit relocation. */
220 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
221 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
222
223 /* A 16 bit relocation without overflow. */
224 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
225 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
226
227 /* The high order 16 bits of an address. */
228 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
229 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
230
231 /* The high order 16 bits of an address, plus 1 if the contents of
232 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
233 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
234 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
235
236 /* An absolute 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero.
237 FIXME: we don't check that, we just clear them. */
238 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
239 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
240
241 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
242 indicate that the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two
243 bits must be zero. */
244 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
245 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
246
247 /* An absolute 16 bit branch, for which bit 10 should be set to
248 indicate that the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower
249 two bits must be zero. */
250 HOW (R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, FALSE, signed,
251 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
252
253 /* A relative 26 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
254 HOW (R_PPC_REL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
255 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
256
257 /* A relative 16 bit branch; the lower two bits must be zero. */
258 HOW (R_PPC_REL14, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
259 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
260
261 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
262 the branch is expected to be taken. The lower two bits must be
263 zero. */
264 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
265 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
266
267 /* A relative 16 bit branch. Bit 10 should be set to indicate that
268 the branch is not expected to be taken. The lower two bits must
269 be zero. */
270 HOW (R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN, 2, 16, 0xfffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
271 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
272
273 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but referring to the GOT table entry for the
274 symbol. */
275 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
276 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
277
278 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the GOT table entry for
279 the symbol. */
280 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
281 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
282
283 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the GOT table entry for
284 the symbol. */
285 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
286 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
287
288 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the GOT table entry for
289 the symbol. */
290 HOW (R_PPC_GOT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
291 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
292
293 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but referring to the procedure linkage table
294 entry for the symbol. */
295 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL24, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
296 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
297
298 /* This is used only by the dynamic linker. The symbol should exist
299 both in the object being run and in some shared library. The
300 dynamic linker copies the data addressed by the symbol from the
301 shared library into the object, because the object being
302 run has to have the data at some particular address. */
303 HOW (R_PPC_COPY, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
304 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
305
306 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but used when setting global offset table
307 entries. */
308 HOW (R_PPC_GLOB_DAT, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
309 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
310
311 /* Marks a procedure linkage table entry for a symbol. */
312 HOW (R_PPC_JMP_SLOT, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
313 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
314
315 /* Used only by the dynamic linker. When the object is run, this
316 longword is set to the load address of the object, plus the
317 addend. */
318 HOW (R_PPC_RELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
319 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
320
321 /* Like R_PPC_REL24, but uses the value of the symbol within the
322 object rather than the final value. Normally used for
323 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
324 HOW (R_PPC_LOCAL24PC, 2, 26, 0x3fffffc, 0, TRUE, signed,
325 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
326
327 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR32, but may be unaligned. */
328 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
329 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
330
331 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16, but may be unaligned. */
332 HOW (R_PPC_UADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, bitfield,
333 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
334
335 /* 32-bit PC relative */
336 HOW (R_PPC_REL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
337 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
338
339 /* 32-bit relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
340 FIXME: not supported. */
341 HOW (R_PPC_PLT32, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
342 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
343
344 /* 32-bit PC relative relocation to the symbol's procedure linkage table.
345 FIXME: not supported. */
346 HOW (R_PPC_PLTREL32, 2, 32, 0, 0, TRUE, dont,
347 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
348
349 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_LO, but referring to the PLT table entry for
350 the symbol. */
351 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
352 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
353
354 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HI, but referring to the PLT table entry for
355 the symbol. */
356 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
357 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
358
359 /* Like R_PPC_ADDR16_HA, but referring to the PLT table entry for
360 the symbol. */
361 HOW (R_PPC_PLT16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
362 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
363
364 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA_BASE_, for use with
365 small data items. */
366 HOW (R_PPC_SDAREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
367 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
368
369 /* 16-bit section relative relocation. */
370 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
371 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
372
373 /* 16-bit lower half section relative relocation. */
374 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
375 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
376
377 /* 16-bit upper half section relative relocation. */
378 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
379 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
380
381 /* 16-bit upper half adjusted section relative relocation. */
382 HOW (R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
383 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
384
385 /* Marker relocs for TLS. */
386 HOW (R_PPC_TLS, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
387 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
388
389 HOW (R_PPC_TLSGD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
390 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
391
392 HOW (R_PPC_TLSLD, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
393 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
394
395 /* Marker relocs on inline plt call instructions. */
396 HOW (R_PPC_PLTSEQ, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
397 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
398
399 HOW (R_PPC_PLTCALL, 2, 32, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
400 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
401
402 /* Computes the load module index of the load module that contains the
403 definition of its TLS sym. */
404 HOW (R_PPC_DTPMOD32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
405 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
406
407 /* Computes a dtv-relative displacement, the difference between the value
408 of sym+add and the base address of the thread-local storage block that
409 contains the definition of sym, minus 0x8000. */
410 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
411 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
412
413 /* A 16 bit dtprel reloc. */
414 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
415 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
416
417 /* Like DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
418 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
419 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
420
421 /* Like DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
422 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
423 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
424
425 /* Like DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
426 HOW (R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
427 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
428
429 /* Computes a tp-relative displacement, the difference between the value of
430 sym+add and the value of the thread pointer (r13). */
431 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
432 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
433
434 /* A 16 bit tprel reloc. */
435 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
436 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
437
438 /* Like TPREL16, but no overflow. */
439 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
440 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
441
442 /* Like TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
443 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
444 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
445
446 /* Like TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
447 HOW (R_PPC_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
448 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
449
450 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
451 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes the offset
452 to the first entry. */
453 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
454 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
455
456 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16, but no overflow. */
457 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
458 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
459
460 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
461 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
462 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
463
464 /* Like GOT_TLSGD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
465 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
466 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
467
468 /* Allocates two contiguous entries in the GOT to hold a tls_index structure,
469 with values (sym+add)@dtpmod and zero, and computes the offset to the
470 first entry. */
471 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
472 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
473
474 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16, but no overflow. */
475 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
476 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
477
478 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
479 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
480 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
481
482 /* Like GOT_TLSLD16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
483 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
484 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
485
486 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@dtprel, and computes
487 the offset to the entry. */
488 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
489 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
490
491 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16, but no overflow. */
492 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
493 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
494
495 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
496 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
497 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
498
499 /* Like GOT_DTPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
500 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
501 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
502
503 /* Allocates an entry in the GOT with value (sym+add)@tprel, and computes the
504 offset to the entry. */
505 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
506 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
507
508 /* Like GOT_TPREL16, but no overflow. */
509 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
510 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
511
512 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_LO, but next higher group of 16 bits. */
513 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
514 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
515
516 /* Like GOT_TPREL16_HI, but adjust for low 16 bits. */
517 HOW (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
518 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
519
520 /* The remaining relocs are from the Embedded ELF ABI, and are not
521 in the SVR4 ELF ABI. */
522
523 /* 32 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
524 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
525 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
526
527 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
528 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
529 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
530
531 /* 16 bit value resulting from the addend minus the symbol. */
532 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
533 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
534
535 /* The high order 16 bits of the addend minus the symbol. */
536 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
537 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
538
539 /* The high order 16 bits of the result of the addend minus the address,
540 plus 1 if the contents of the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number,
541 is negative. */
542 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, FALSE, dont,
543 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
544
545 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
546 address in the .sdata section, and returning the offset from
547 _SDA_BASE_ for that relocation. */
548 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
549 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
550
551 /* 16 bit value resulting from allocating a 4 byte word to hold an
552 address in the .sdata2 section, and returning the offset from
553 _SDA2_BASE_ for that relocation. */
554 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
555 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
556
557 /* A sign-extended 16 bit value relative to _SDA2_BASE_, for use with
558 small data items. */
559 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
560 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
561
562 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling in the 16 bit
563 signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the register
564 field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
565 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
566 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
567
568 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF */
569 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16 */
570 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO */
571 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI */
572 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA */
573 /* Relocation not handled: R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD */
574
575 /* PC relative relocation against either _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_, filling
576 in the 16 bit signed offset from the appropriate base, and filling in the
577 register field with the appropriate register (0, 2, or 13). */
578 HOW (R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
579 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
580
581 /* A relative 8 bit branch. */
582 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL8, 1, 8, 0xff, 1, TRUE, signed,
583 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
584
585 /* A relative 15 bit branch. */
586 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL15, 2, 16, 0xfffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
587 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
588
589 /* A relative 24 bit branch. */
590 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_REL24, 2, 25, 0x1fffffe, 0, TRUE, signed,
591 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
592
593 /* The 16 LSBS in split16a format. */
594 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
595 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
596
597 /* The 16 LSBS in split16d format. */
598 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
599 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
600
601 /* Bits 16-31 split16a format. */
602 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
603 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
604
605 /* Bits 16-31 split16d format. */
606 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
607 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
608
609 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16a format. */
610 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
611 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
612
613 /* Bits 16-31 (High Adjusted) in split16d format. */
614 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
615 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
616
617 /* This reloc is like R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 but only applies to e_add16i
618 instructions. If the register base is 0 then the linker changes
619 the e_add16i to an e_li instruction. */
620 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
621 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
622
623 /* Like R_PPC_VLE_SDA21 but ignore overflow. */
624 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO, 2, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
625 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
626
627 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
628 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
629 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
630
631 /* The 16 LSBS relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
632 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 0, FALSE, dont,
633 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
634
635 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16a format. */
636 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
637 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
638
639 /* Bits 16-31 relative to _SDA_BASE_ in split16d format. */
640 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
641 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
642
643 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16a format. */
644 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A, 2, 16, 0x1f07ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
645 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
646
647 /* Bits 16-31 (HA) relative to _SDA_BASE split16d format. */
648 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D, 2, 16, 0x3e007ff, 16, FALSE, dont,
649 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
650
651 /* e_li split20 format. */
652 HOW (R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20, 2, 20, 0x1f7fff, 0, FALSE, dont,
653 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
654
655 HOW (R_PPC_IRELATIVE, 2, 32, 0xffffffff, 0, FALSE, dont,
656 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
657
658 /* A 16 bit relative relocation. */
659 HOW (R_PPC_REL16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, signed,
660 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
661
662 /* A 16 bit relative relocation without overflow. */
663 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_LO, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, TRUE, dont,
664 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
665
666 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address. */
667 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HI, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
668 bfd_elf_generic_reloc),
669
670 /* The high order 16 bits of a relative address, plus 1 if the contents of
671 the low 16 bits, treated as a signed number, is negative. */
672 HOW (R_PPC_REL16_HA, 1, 16, 0xffff, 16, TRUE, dont,
673 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
674
675 /* Like R_PPC_REL16_HA but for split field in addpcis. */
676 HOW (R_PPC_REL16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, TRUE, signed,
677 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
678
679 /* A split-field reloc for addpcis, non-relative (gas internal use only). */
680 HOW (R_PPC_16DX_HA, 2, 16, 0x1fffc1, 16, FALSE, signed,
681 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc),
682
683 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable hierarchy. */
684 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
685 NULL),
686
687 /* GNU extension to record C++ vtable member usage. */
688 HOW (R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY, 0, 0, 0, 0, FALSE, dont,
689 NULL),
690
691 /* Phony reloc to handle AIX style TOC entries. */
692 HOW (R_PPC_TOC16, 1, 16, 0xffff, 0, FALSE, signed,
693 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc),
694 };
695 \f
696 /* Initialize the ppc_elf_howto_table, so that linear accesses can be done. */
697
698 static void
699 ppc_elf_howto_init (void)
700 {
701 unsigned int i, type;
702
703 for (i = 0;
704 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
705 i++)
706 {
707 type = ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].type;
708 if (type >= (sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table)
709 / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_table[0])))
710 abort ();
711 ppc_elf_howto_table[type] = &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
712 }
713 }
714
715 static reloc_howto_type *
716 ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
717 bfd_reloc_code_real_type code)
718 {
719 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r;
720
721 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
722 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
723 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
724
725 switch (code)
726 {
727 default:
728 return NULL;
729
730 case BFD_RELOC_NONE: r = R_PPC_NONE; break;
731 case BFD_RELOC_32: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
732 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA26: r = R_PPC_ADDR24; break;
733 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_DS:
734 case BFD_RELOC_16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16; break;
735 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_ADDR16_LO_DS:
736 case BFD_RELOC_LO16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_LO; break;
737 case BFD_RELOC_HI16: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HI; break;
738 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S: r = R_PPC_ADDR16_HA; break;
739 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16: r = R_PPC_ADDR14; break;
740 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN; break;
741 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_BA16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN; break;
742 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B26: r = R_PPC_REL24; break;
743 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16: r = R_PPC_REL14; break;
744 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN; break;
745 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_B16_BRNTAKEN: r = R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN; break;
746 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_DS:
747 case BFD_RELOC_16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16; break;
748 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_GOT16_LO_DS:
749 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_LO; break;
750 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HI; break;
751 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_GOTOFF: r = R_PPC_GOT16_HA; break;
752 case BFD_RELOC_24_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL24; break;
753 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_COPY: r = R_PPC_COPY; break;
754 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GLOB_DAT: r = R_PPC_GLOB_DAT; break;
755 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_LOCAL24PC: r = R_PPC_LOCAL24PC; break;
756 case BFD_RELOC_32_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL32; break;
757 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT32; break;
758 case BFD_RELOC_32_PLT_PCREL: r = R_PPC_PLTREL32; break;
759 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS:
760 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_LO; break;
761 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HI; break;
762 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PLTOFF: r = R_PPC_PLT16_HA; break;
763 case BFD_RELOC_GPREL16: r = R_PPC_SDAREL16; break;
764 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_DS:
765 case BFD_RELOC_16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF; break;
766 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_SECTOFF_LO_DS:
767 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO; break;
768 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI; break;
769 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_BASEREL: r = R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA; break;
770 case BFD_RELOC_CTOR: r = R_PPC_ADDR32; break;
771 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TOC16_DS:
772 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TOC16: r = R_PPC_TOC16; break;
773 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLS: r = R_PPC_TLS; break;
774 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSGD: r = R_PPC_TLSGD; break;
775 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TLSLD: r = R_PPC_TLSLD; break;
776 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPMOD: r = R_PPC_DTPMOD32; break;
777 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_DS:
778 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_TPREL16; break;
779 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_TPREL16_LO_DS:
780 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO; break;
781 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HI; break;
782 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA; break;
783 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_TPREL: r = R_PPC_TPREL32; break;
784 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_DS:
785 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16; break;
786 case BFD_RELOC_PPC64_DTPREL16_LO_DS:
787 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO; break;
788 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI; break;
789 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA; break;
790 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_DTPREL: r = R_PPC_DTPREL32; break;
791 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16; break;
792 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO; break;
793 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI; break;
794 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA; break;
795 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16; break;
796 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO; break;
797 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI; break;
798 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA; break;
799 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16; break;
800 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO; break;
801 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI; break;
802 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA; break;
803 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16; break;
804 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO; break;
805 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI; break;
806 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA: r = R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA; break;
807 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR32: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32; break;
808 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16; break;
809 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO; break;
810 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI; break;
811 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA; break;
812 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDAI16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16; break;
813 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16; break;
814 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL; break;
815 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_SDA21: r = R_PPC_EMB_SDA21; break;
816 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_MRKREF: r = R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF; break;
817 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16; break;
818 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO; break;
819 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI; break;
820 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA; break;
821 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD: r = R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD; break;
822 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_EMB_RELSDA: r = R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA; break;
823 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL8: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL8; break;
824 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL15: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL15; break;
825 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_REL24: r = R_PPC_VLE_REL24; break;
826 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16A; break;
827 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_LO16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_LO16D; break;
828 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16A; break;
829 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HI16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HI16D; break;
830 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16A: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16A; break;
831 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_HA16D: r = R_PPC_VLE_HA16D; break;
832 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21; break;
833 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO: r = R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO; break;
834 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
835 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A;
836 break;
837 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
838 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D;
839 break;
840 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
841 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A;
842 break;
843 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
844 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D;
845 break;
846 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
847 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A;
848 break;
849 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
850 r = R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D;
851 break;
852 case BFD_RELOC_16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16; break;
853 case BFD_RELOC_LO16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_LO; break;
854 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HI; break;
855 case BFD_RELOC_HI16_S_PCREL: r = R_PPC_REL16_HA; break;
856 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_16DX_HA; break;
857 case BFD_RELOC_PPC_REL16DX_HA: r = R_PPC_REL16DX_HA; break;
858 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_INHERIT: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT; break;
859 case BFD_RELOC_VTABLE_ENTRY: r = R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY; break;
860 }
861
862 return ppc_elf_howto_table[r];
863 };
864
865 static reloc_howto_type *
866 ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
867 const char *r_name)
868 {
869 unsigned int i;
870
871 for (i = 0;
872 i < sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw) / sizeof (ppc_elf_howto_raw[0]);
873 i++)
874 if (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name != NULL
875 && strcasecmp (ppc_elf_howto_raw[i].name, r_name) == 0)
876 return &ppc_elf_howto_raw[i];
877
878 return NULL;
879 }
880
881 /* Set the howto pointer for a PowerPC ELF reloc. */
882
883 static bfd_boolean
884 ppc_elf_info_to_howto (bfd *abfd,
885 arelent *cache_ptr,
886 Elf_Internal_Rela *dst)
887 {
888 unsigned int r_type;
889
890 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
891 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
892 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
893
894 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info);
895 if (r_type >= R_PPC_max)
896 {
897 /* xgettext:c-format */
898 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
899 abfd, r_type);
900 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
901 return FALSE;
902 }
903
904 cache_ptr->howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
905
906 /* Just because the above assert didn't trigger doesn't mean that
907 ELF32_R_TYPE (dst->r_info) is necessarily a valid relocation. */
908 if (cache_ptr->howto == NULL)
909 {
910 /* xgettext:c-format */
911 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: unsupported relocation type %#x"),
912 abfd, r_type);
913 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
914
915 return FALSE;
916 }
917
918 return TRUE;
919 }
920
921 /* Handle the R_PPC_ADDR16_HA and R_PPC_REL16_HA relocs. */
922
923 static bfd_reloc_status_type
924 ppc_elf_addr16_ha_reloc (bfd *abfd,
925 arelent *reloc_entry,
926 asymbol *symbol,
927 void *data,
928 asection *input_section,
929 bfd *output_bfd,
930 char **error_message ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
931 {
932 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
933 long insn;
934 bfd_size_type octets;
935 bfd_vma value;
936
937 if (output_bfd != NULL)
938 {
939 reloc_entry->address += input_section->output_offset;
940 return bfd_reloc_ok;
941 }
942
943 reloc_entry->addend += 0x8000;
944 r_type = reloc_entry->howto->type;
945 if (r_type != R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
946 return bfd_reloc_continue;
947
948 value = 0;
949 if (!bfd_is_com_section (symbol->section))
950 value = symbol->value;
951 value += (reloc_entry->addend
952 + symbol->section->output_offset
953 + symbol->section->output_section->vma);
954 value -= (reloc_entry->address
955 + input_section->output_offset
956 + input_section->output_section->vma);
957 value >>= 16;
958
959 octets = reloc_entry->address * bfd_octets_per_byte (abfd);
960 insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
961 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
962 insn |= (value & 0xffc1) | ((value & 0x3e) << 15);
963 bfd_put_32 (abfd, insn, (bfd_byte *) data + octets);
964 return bfd_reloc_ok;
965 }
966
967 static bfd_reloc_status_type
968 ppc_elf_unhandled_reloc (bfd *abfd,
969 arelent *reloc_entry,
970 asymbol *symbol,
971 void *data,
972 asection *input_section,
973 bfd *output_bfd,
974 char **error_message)
975 {
976 /* If this is a relocatable link (output_bfd test tells us), just
977 call the generic function. Any adjustment will be done at final
978 link time. */
979 if (output_bfd != NULL)
980 return bfd_elf_generic_reloc (abfd, reloc_entry, symbol, data,
981 input_section, output_bfd, error_message);
982
983 if (error_message != NULL)
984 {
985 static char buf[60];
986 sprintf (buf, _("generic linker can't handle %s"),
987 reloc_entry->howto->name);
988 *error_message = buf;
989 }
990 return bfd_reloc_dangerous;
991 }
992 \f
993 /* Sections created by the linker. */
994
995 typedef struct elf_linker_section
996 {
997 /* Pointer to the bfd section. */
998 asection *section;
999 /* Section name. */
1000 const char *name;
1001 /* Associated bss section name. */
1002 const char *bss_name;
1003 /* Associated symbol name. */
1004 const char *sym_name;
1005 /* Associated symbol. */
1006 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sym;
1007 } elf_linker_section_t;
1008
1009 /* Linked list of allocated pointer entries. This hangs off of the
1010 symbol lists, and provides allows us to return different pointers,
1011 based on different addend's. */
1012
1013 typedef struct elf_linker_section_pointers
1014 {
1015 /* next allocated pointer for this symbol */
1016 struct elf_linker_section_pointers *next;
1017 /* offset of pointer from beginning of section */
1018 bfd_vma offset;
1019 /* addend used */
1020 bfd_vma addend;
1021 /* which linker section this is */
1022 elf_linker_section_t *lsect;
1023 } elf_linker_section_pointers_t;
1024
1025 struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata
1026 {
1027 struct elf_obj_tdata elf;
1028
1029 /* A mapping from local symbols to offsets into the various linker
1030 sections added. This is index by the symbol index. */
1031 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **linker_section_pointers;
1032
1033 /* Flags used to auto-detect plt type. */
1034 unsigned int makes_plt_call : 1;
1035 unsigned int has_rel16 : 1;
1036 };
1037
1038 #define ppc_elf_tdata(bfd) \
1039 ((struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata *) (bfd)->tdata.any)
1040
1041 #define elf_local_ptr_offsets(bfd) \
1042 (ppc_elf_tdata (bfd)->linker_section_pointers)
1043
1044 #define is_ppc_elf(bfd) \
1045 (bfd_get_flavour (bfd) == bfd_target_elf_flavour \
1046 && elf_object_id (bfd) == PPC32_ELF_DATA)
1047
1048 /* Override the generic function because we store some extras. */
1049
1050 static bfd_boolean
1051 ppc_elf_mkobject (bfd *abfd)
1052 {
1053 return bfd_elf_allocate_object (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_obj_tdata),
1054 PPC32_ELF_DATA);
1055 }
1056
1057 /* When defaulting arch/mach, decode apuinfo to find a better match. */
1058
1059 bfd_boolean
1060 _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (bfd *abfd)
1061 {
1062 unsigned long mach = 0;
1063 asection *s;
1064 unsigned char *contents;
1065
1066 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32
1067 && bfd_big_endian (abfd))
1068 {
1069
1070 for (s = abfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
1071 if ((elf_section_data (s)->this_hdr.sh_flags & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1072 break;
1073 if (s != NULL)
1074 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1075 }
1076
1077 if (mach == 0)
1078 {
1079 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1080 if (s != NULL
1081 && s->size >= 24
1082 && bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, s, &contents))
1083 {
1084 unsigned int apuinfo_size = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + 4);
1085 unsigned int i;
1086
1087 for (i = 20; i < apuinfo_size + 20 && i + 4 <= s->size; i += 4)
1088 {
1089 unsigned int val = bfd_get_32 (abfd, contents + i);
1090 switch (val >> 16)
1091 {
1092 case PPC_APUINFO_PMR:
1093 case PPC_APUINFO_RFMCI:
1094 if (mach == 0)
1095 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_titan;
1096 break;
1097
1098 case PPC_APUINFO_ISEL:
1099 case PPC_APUINFO_CACHELCK:
1100 if (mach == bfd_mach_ppc_titan)
1101 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500mc;
1102 break;
1103
1104 case PPC_APUINFO_SPE:
1105 case PPC_APUINFO_EFS:
1106 case PPC_APUINFO_BRLOCK:
1107 if (mach != bfd_mach_ppc_vle)
1108 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_e500;
1109 break;
1110
1111 case PPC_APUINFO_VLE:
1112 mach = bfd_mach_ppc_vle;
1113 break;
1114
1115 default:
1116 mach = -1ul;
1117 }
1118 }
1119 free (contents);
1120 }
1121 }
1122
1123 if (mach != 0 && mach != -1ul)
1124 {
1125 const bfd_arch_info_type *arch;
1126
1127 for (arch = abfd->arch_info->next; arch; arch = arch->next)
1128 if (arch->mach == mach)
1129 {
1130 abfd->arch_info = arch;
1131 break;
1132 }
1133 }
1134 return TRUE;
1135 }
1136
1137 /* Fix bad default arch selected for a 32 bit input bfd when the
1138 default is 64 bit. Also select arch based on apuinfo. */
1139
1140 static bfd_boolean
1141 ppc_elf_object_p (bfd *abfd)
1142 {
1143 if (!abfd->arch_info->the_default)
1144 return TRUE;
1145
1146 if (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 64)
1147 {
1148 Elf_Internal_Ehdr *i_ehdr = elf_elfheader (abfd);
1149
1150 if (i_ehdr->e_ident[EI_CLASS] == ELFCLASS32)
1151 {
1152 /* Relies on arch after 64 bit default being 32 bit default. */
1153 abfd->arch_info = abfd->arch_info->next;
1154 BFD_ASSERT (abfd->arch_info->bits_per_word == 32);
1155 }
1156 }
1157 return _bfd_elf_ppc_set_arch (abfd);
1158 }
1159
1160 /* Function to set whether a module needs the -mrelocatable bit set. */
1161
1162 static bfd_boolean
1163 ppc_elf_set_private_flags (bfd *abfd, flagword flags)
1164 {
1165 BFD_ASSERT (!elf_flags_init (abfd)
1166 || elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags == flags);
1167
1168 elf_elfheader (abfd)->e_flags = flags;
1169 elf_flags_init (abfd) = TRUE;
1170 return TRUE;
1171 }
1172
1173 /* Support for core dump NOTE sections. */
1174
1175 static bfd_boolean
1176 ppc_elf_grok_prstatus (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1177 {
1178 int offset;
1179 unsigned int size;
1180
1181 switch (note->descsz)
1182 {
1183 default:
1184 return FALSE;
1185
1186 case 268: /* Linux/PPC. */
1187 /* pr_cursig */
1188 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->signal = bfd_get_16 (abfd, note->descdata + 12);
1189
1190 /* pr_pid */
1191 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->lwpid = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 24);
1192
1193 /* pr_reg */
1194 offset = 72;
1195 size = 192;
1196
1197 break;
1198 }
1199
1200 /* Make a ".reg/999" section. */
1201 return _bfd_elfcore_make_pseudosection (abfd, ".reg",
1202 size, note->descpos + offset);
1203 }
1204
1205 static bfd_boolean
1206 ppc_elf_grok_psinfo (bfd *abfd, Elf_Internal_Note *note)
1207 {
1208 switch (note->descsz)
1209 {
1210 default:
1211 return FALSE;
1212
1213 case 128: /* Linux/PPC elf_prpsinfo. */
1214 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->pid
1215 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, note->descdata + 16);
1216 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->program
1217 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 32, 16);
1218 elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command
1219 = _bfd_elfcore_strndup (abfd, note->descdata + 48, 80);
1220 }
1221
1222 /* Note that for some reason, a spurious space is tacked
1223 onto the end of the args in some (at least one anyway)
1224 implementations, so strip it off if it exists. */
1225
1226 {
1227 char *command = elf_tdata (abfd)->core->command;
1228 int n = strlen (command);
1229
1230 if (0 < n && command[n - 1] == ' ')
1231 command[n - 1] = '\0';
1232 }
1233
1234 return TRUE;
1235 }
1236
1237 static char *
1238 ppc_elf_write_core_note (bfd *abfd, char *buf, int *bufsiz, int note_type, ...)
1239 {
1240 switch (note_type)
1241 {
1242 default:
1243 return NULL;
1244
1245 case NT_PRPSINFO:
1246 {
1247 char data[128] ATTRIBUTE_NONSTRING;
1248 va_list ap;
1249
1250 va_start (ap, note_type);
1251 memset (data, 0, sizeof (data));
1252 strncpy (data + 32, va_arg (ap, const char *), 16);
1253 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1254 DIAGNOSTIC_PUSH;
1255 /* GCC 8.0 and 8.1 warn about 80 equals destination size with
1256 -Wstringop-truncation:
1257 https://gcc.gnu.org/bugzilla/show_bug.cgi?id=85643
1258 */
1259 DIAGNOSTIC_IGNORE_STRINGOP_TRUNCATION;
1260 #endif
1261 strncpy (data + 48, va_arg (ap, const char *), 80);
1262 #if GCC_VERSION == 8000 || GCC_VERSION == 8001
1263 DIAGNOSTIC_POP;
1264 #endif
1265 va_end (ap);
1266 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1267 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1268 }
1269
1270 case NT_PRSTATUS:
1271 {
1272 char data[268];
1273 va_list ap;
1274 long pid;
1275 int cursig;
1276 const void *greg;
1277
1278 va_start (ap, note_type);
1279 memset (data, 0, 72);
1280 pid = va_arg (ap, long);
1281 bfd_put_32 (abfd, pid, data + 24);
1282 cursig = va_arg (ap, int);
1283 bfd_put_16 (abfd, cursig, data + 12);
1284 greg = va_arg (ap, const void *);
1285 memcpy (data + 72, greg, 192);
1286 memset (data + 264, 0, 4);
1287 va_end (ap);
1288 return elfcore_write_note (abfd, buf, bufsiz,
1289 "CORE", note_type, data, sizeof (data));
1290 }
1291 }
1292 }
1293
1294 static flagword
1295 ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags (char *flag_name)
1296 {
1297
1298 if (!strcmp (flag_name, "SHF_PPC_VLE"))
1299 return SHF_PPC_VLE;
1300
1301 return 0;
1302 }
1303
1304 /* Return address for Ith PLT stub in section PLT, for relocation REL
1305 or (bfd_vma) -1 if it should not be included. */
1306
1307 static bfd_vma
1308 ppc_elf_plt_sym_val (bfd_vma i ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1309 const asection *plt ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1310 const arelent *rel)
1311 {
1312 return rel->address;
1313 }
1314
1315 /* Handle a PowerPC specific section when reading an object file. This
1316 is called when bfd_section_from_shdr finds a section with an unknown
1317 type. */
1318
1319 static bfd_boolean
1320 ppc_elf_section_from_shdr (bfd *abfd,
1321 Elf_Internal_Shdr *hdr,
1322 const char *name,
1323 int shindex)
1324 {
1325 asection *newsect;
1326 flagword flags;
1327
1328 if (! _bfd_elf_make_section_from_shdr (abfd, hdr, name, shindex))
1329 return FALSE;
1330
1331 newsect = hdr->bfd_section;
1332 flags = bfd_section_flags (newsect);
1333 if (hdr->sh_flags & SHF_EXCLUDE)
1334 flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
1335
1336 if (hdr->sh_type == SHT_ORDERED)
1337 flags |= SEC_SORT_ENTRIES;
1338
1339 bfd_set_section_flags (newsect, flags);
1340 return TRUE;
1341 }
1342
1343 /* Set up any other section flags and such that may be necessary. */
1344
1345 static bfd_boolean
1346 ppc_elf_fake_sections (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1347 Elf_Internal_Shdr *shdr,
1348 asection *asect)
1349 {
1350 if ((asect->flags & SEC_SORT_ENTRIES) != 0)
1351 shdr->sh_type = SHT_ORDERED;
1352
1353 return TRUE;
1354 }
1355
1356 /* If we have .sbss2 or .PPC.EMB.sbss0 output sections, we
1357 need to bump up the number of section headers. */
1358
1359 static int
1360 ppc_elf_additional_program_headers (bfd *abfd,
1361 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1362 {
1363 asection *s;
1364 int ret = 0;
1365
1366 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".sbss2");
1367 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1368 ++ret;
1369
1370 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0");
1371 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0)
1372 ++ret;
1373
1374 return ret;
1375 }
1376
1377 /* Modify the segment map for VLE executables. */
1378
1379 bfd_boolean
1380 ppc_elf_modify_segment_map (bfd *abfd,
1381 struct bfd_link_info *info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1382 {
1383 struct elf_segment_map *m;
1384
1385 /* At this point in the link, output sections have already been sorted by
1386 LMA and assigned to segments. All that is left to do is to ensure
1387 there is no mixing of VLE & non-VLE sections in a text segment.
1388 If we find that case, we split the segment.
1389 We maintain the original output section order. */
1390
1391 for (m = elf_seg_map (abfd); m != NULL; m = m->next)
1392 {
1393 struct elf_segment_map *n;
1394 bfd_size_type amt;
1395 unsigned int j, k;
1396 unsigned int p_flags;
1397
1398 if (m->p_type != PT_LOAD || m->count == 0)
1399 continue;
1400
1401 for (p_flags = PF_R, j = 0; j != m->count; ++j)
1402 {
1403 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1404 p_flags |= PF_W;
1405 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1406 {
1407 p_flags |= PF_X;
1408 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1409 p_flags |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1410 break;
1411 }
1412 }
1413 if (j != m->count)
1414 while (++j != m->count)
1415 {
1416 unsigned int p_flags1 = PF_R;
1417
1418 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_READONLY) == 0)
1419 p_flags1 |= PF_W;
1420 if ((m->sections[j]->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
1421 {
1422 p_flags1 |= PF_X;
1423 if ((elf_section_flags (m->sections[j]) & SHF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1424 p_flags1 |= PF_PPC_VLE;
1425 if (((p_flags1 ^ p_flags) & PF_PPC_VLE) != 0)
1426 break;
1427 }
1428 p_flags |= p_flags1;
1429 }
1430 /* If we're splitting a segment which originally contained rw
1431 sections then those sections might now only be in one of the
1432 two parts. So always set p_flags if splitting, even if we
1433 are being called for objcopy with p_flags_valid set. */
1434 if (j != m->count || !m->p_flags_valid)
1435 {
1436 m->p_flags_valid = 1;
1437 m->p_flags = p_flags;
1438 }
1439 if (j == m->count)
1440 continue;
1441
1442 /* Sections 0..j-1 stay in this (current) segment,
1443 the remainder are put in a new segment.
1444 The scan resumes with the new segment. */
1445
1446 amt = sizeof (struct elf_segment_map);
1447 amt += (m->count - j - 1) * sizeof (asection *);
1448 n = (struct elf_segment_map *) bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
1449 if (n == NULL)
1450 return FALSE;
1451
1452 n->p_type = PT_LOAD;
1453 n->count = m->count - j;
1454 for (k = 0; k < n->count; ++k)
1455 n->sections[k] = m->sections[j + k];
1456 m->count = j;
1457 m->p_size_valid = 0;
1458 n->next = m->next;
1459 m->next = n;
1460 }
1461
1462 return TRUE;
1463 }
1464
1465 /* Add extra PPC sections -- Note, for now, make .sbss2 and
1466 .PPC.EMB.sbss0 a normal section, and not a bss section so
1467 that the linker doesn't crater when trying to make more than
1468 2 sections. */
1469
1470 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_elf_special_sections[] =
1471 {
1472 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_EXECINSTR },
1473 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss"), -2, SHT_NOBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1474 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sbss2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1475 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE },
1476 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".sdata2"), -2, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1477 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".tags"), 0, SHT_ORDERED, SHF_ALLOC },
1478 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (APUINFO_SECTION_NAME), 0, SHT_NOTE, 0 },
1479 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sbss0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1480 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".PPC.EMB.sdata0"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC },
1481 { NULL, 0, 0, 0, 0 }
1482 };
1483
1484 /* This is what we want for new plt/got. */
1485 static struct bfd_elf_special_section ppc_alt_plt =
1486 { STRING_COMMA_LEN (".plt"), 0, SHT_PROGBITS, SHF_ALLOC };
1487
1488 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
1489 ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
1490 {
1491 const struct bfd_elf_special_section *ssect;
1492
1493 /* See if this is one of the special sections. */
1494 if (sec->name == NULL)
1495 return NULL;
1496
1497 ssect = _bfd_elf_get_special_section (sec->name, ppc_elf_special_sections,
1498 sec->use_rela_p);
1499 if (ssect != NULL)
1500 {
1501 if (ssect == ppc_elf_special_sections && (sec->flags & SEC_LOAD) != 0)
1502 ssect = &ppc_alt_plt;
1503 return ssect;
1504 }
1505
1506 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
1507 }
1508 \f
1509 /* Very simple linked list structure for recording apuinfo values. */
1510 typedef struct apuinfo_list
1511 {
1512 struct apuinfo_list *next;
1513 unsigned long value;
1514 }
1515 apuinfo_list;
1516
1517 static apuinfo_list *head;
1518 static bfd_boolean apuinfo_set;
1519
1520 static void
1521 apuinfo_list_init (void)
1522 {
1523 head = NULL;
1524 apuinfo_set = FALSE;
1525 }
1526
1527 static void
1528 apuinfo_list_add (unsigned long value)
1529 {
1530 apuinfo_list *entry = head;
1531
1532 while (entry != NULL)
1533 {
1534 if (entry->value == value)
1535 return;
1536 entry = entry->next;
1537 }
1538
1539 entry = bfd_malloc (sizeof (* entry));
1540 if (entry == NULL)
1541 return;
1542
1543 entry->value = value;
1544 entry->next = head;
1545 head = entry;
1546 }
1547
1548 static unsigned
1549 apuinfo_list_length (void)
1550 {
1551 apuinfo_list *entry;
1552 unsigned long count;
1553
1554 for (entry = head, count = 0;
1555 entry;
1556 entry = entry->next)
1557 ++ count;
1558
1559 return count;
1560 }
1561
1562 static inline unsigned long
1563 apuinfo_list_element (unsigned long number)
1564 {
1565 apuinfo_list * entry;
1566
1567 for (entry = head;
1568 entry && number --;
1569 entry = entry->next)
1570 ;
1571
1572 return entry ? entry->value : 0;
1573 }
1574
1575 static void
1576 apuinfo_list_finish (void)
1577 {
1578 apuinfo_list *entry;
1579
1580 for (entry = head; entry;)
1581 {
1582 apuinfo_list *next = entry->next;
1583 free (entry);
1584 entry = next;
1585 }
1586
1587 head = NULL;
1588 }
1589
1590 /* Scan the input BFDs and create a linked list of
1591 the APUinfo values that will need to be emitted. */
1592
1593 static void
1594 ppc_elf_begin_write_processing (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *link_info)
1595 {
1596 bfd *ibfd;
1597 asection *asec;
1598 char *buffer = NULL;
1599 bfd_size_type largest_input_size = 0;
1600 unsigned i;
1601 unsigned long length;
1602 const char *error_message = NULL;
1603
1604 if (link_info == NULL)
1605 return;
1606
1607 apuinfo_list_init ();
1608
1609 /* Read in the input sections contents. */
1610 for (ibfd = link_info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
1611 {
1612 unsigned long datum;
1613
1614 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1615 if (asec == NULL)
1616 continue;
1617
1618 /* xgettext:c-format */
1619 error_message = _("corrupt %s section in %pB");
1620 length = asec->size;
1621 if (length < 20)
1622 goto fail;
1623
1624 apuinfo_set = TRUE;
1625 if (largest_input_size < asec->size)
1626 {
1627 if (buffer)
1628 free (buffer);
1629 largest_input_size = asec->size;
1630 buffer = bfd_malloc (largest_input_size);
1631 if (!buffer)
1632 return;
1633 }
1634
1635 if (bfd_seek (ibfd, asec->filepos, SEEK_SET) != 0
1636 || (bfd_bread (buffer, length, ibfd) != length))
1637 {
1638 /* xgettext:c-format */
1639 error_message = _("unable to read in %s section from %pB");
1640 goto fail;
1641 }
1642
1643 /* Verify the contents of the header. Note - we have to
1644 extract the values this way in order to allow for a
1645 host whose endian-ness is different from the target. */
1646 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer);
1647 if (datum != sizeof APUINFO_LABEL)
1648 goto fail;
1649
1650 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 8);
1651 if (datum != 0x2)
1652 goto fail;
1653
1654 if (strcmp (buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL) != 0)
1655 goto fail;
1656
1657 /* Get the number of bytes used for apuinfo entries. */
1658 datum = bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 4);
1659 if (datum + 20 != length)
1660 goto fail;
1661
1662 /* Scan the apuinfo section, building a list of apuinfo numbers. */
1663 for (i = 0; i < datum; i += 4)
1664 apuinfo_list_add (bfd_get_32 (ibfd, buffer + 20 + i));
1665 }
1666
1667 error_message = NULL;
1668
1669 if (apuinfo_set)
1670 {
1671 /* Compute the size of the output section. */
1672 unsigned num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1673
1674 /* Set the output section size, if it exists. */
1675 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1676
1677 if (asec && !bfd_set_section_size (asec, 20 + num_entries * 4))
1678 {
1679 ibfd = abfd;
1680 /* xgettext:c-format */
1681 error_message = _("warning: unable to set size of %s section in %pB");
1682 }
1683 }
1684
1685 fail:
1686 if (buffer)
1687 free (buffer);
1688
1689 if (error_message)
1690 _bfd_error_handler (error_message, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME, ibfd);
1691 }
1692
1693 /* Prevent the output section from accumulating the input sections'
1694 contents. We have already stored this in our linked list structure. */
1695
1696 static bfd_boolean
1697 ppc_elf_write_section (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1698 struct bfd_link_info *link_info ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
1699 asection *asec,
1700 bfd_byte *contents ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED)
1701 {
1702 return apuinfo_set && strcmp (asec->name, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME) == 0;
1703 }
1704
1705 /* Finally we can generate the output section. */
1706
1707 static void
1708 ppc_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1709 {
1710 bfd_byte *buffer;
1711 asection *asec;
1712 unsigned i;
1713 unsigned num_entries;
1714 bfd_size_type length;
1715
1716 asec = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, APUINFO_SECTION_NAME);
1717 if (asec == NULL)
1718 return;
1719
1720 if (!apuinfo_set)
1721 return;
1722
1723 length = asec->size;
1724 if (length < 20)
1725 return;
1726
1727 buffer = bfd_malloc (length);
1728 if (buffer == NULL)
1729 {
1730 _bfd_error_handler
1731 (_("failed to allocate space for new APUinfo section"));
1732 return;
1733 }
1734
1735 /* Create the apuinfo header. */
1736 num_entries = apuinfo_list_length ();
1737 bfd_put_32 (abfd, sizeof APUINFO_LABEL, buffer);
1738 bfd_put_32 (abfd, num_entries * 4, buffer + 4);
1739 bfd_put_32 (abfd, 0x2, buffer + 8);
1740 strcpy ((char *) buffer + 12, APUINFO_LABEL);
1741
1742 length = 20;
1743 for (i = 0; i < num_entries; i++)
1744 {
1745 bfd_put_32 (abfd, apuinfo_list_element (i), buffer + length);
1746 length += 4;
1747 }
1748
1749 if (length != asec->size)
1750 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to compute new APUinfo section"));
1751
1752 if (! bfd_set_section_contents (abfd, asec, buffer, (file_ptr) 0, length))
1753 _bfd_error_handler (_("failed to install new APUinfo section"));
1754
1755 free (buffer);
1756
1757 apuinfo_list_finish ();
1758 }
1759
1760 static bfd_boolean
1761 ppc_elf_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
1762 {
1763 ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
1764 return _bfd_elf_final_write_processing (abfd);
1765 }
1766 \f
1767 static bfd_boolean
1768 is_nonpic_glink_stub (bfd *abfd, asection *glink, bfd_vma off)
1769 {
1770 bfd_byte buf[4 * 4];
1771
1772 if (!bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf, off, sizeof buf))
1773 return FALSE;
1774
1775 return ((bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 0) & 0xffff0000) == LIS_11
1776 && (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 4) & 0xffff0000) == LWZ_11_11
1777 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 8) == MTCTR_11
1778 && bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf + 12) == BCTR);
1779 }
1780
1781 static bfd_boolean
1782 section_covers_vma (bfd *abfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED, asection *section, void *ptr)
1783 {
1784 bfd_vma vma = *(bfd_vma *) ptr;
1785 return ((section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0
1786 && section->vma <= vma
1787 && vma < section->vma + section->size);
1788 }
1789
1790 static long
1791 ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (bfd *abfd, long symcount, asymbol **syms,
1792 long dynsymcount, asymbol **dynsyms,
1793 asymbol **ret)
1794 {
1795 bfd_boolean (*slurp_relocs) (bfd *, asection *, asymbol **, bfd_boolean);
1796 asection *plt, *relplt, *dynamic, *glink;
1797 bfd_vma glink_vma = 0;
1798 bfd_vma resolv_vma = 0;
1799 bfd_vma stub_off;
1800 asymbol *s;
1801 arelent *p;
1802 long count, i, stub_delta;
1803 size_t size;
1804 char *names;
1805 bfd_byte buf[4];
1806
1807 *ret = NULL;
1808
1809 if ((abfd->flags & (DYNAMIC | EXEC_P)) == 0)
1810 return 0;
1811
1812 if (dynsymcount <= 0)
1813 return 0;
1814
1815 relplt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".rela.plt");
1816 if (relplt == NULL)
1817 return 0;
1818
1819 plt = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".plt");
1820 if (plt == NULL)
1821 return 0;
1822
1823 /* Call common code to handle old-style executable PLTs. */
1824 if (elf_section_flags (plt) & SHF_EXECINSTR)
1825 return _bfd_elf_get_synthetic_symtab (abfd, symcount, syms,
1826 dynsymcount, dynsyms, ret);
1827
1828 /* If this object was prelinked, the prelinker stored the address
1829 of .glink at got[1]. If it wasn't prelinked, got[1] will be zero. */
1830 dynamic = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".dynamic");
1831 if (dynamic != NULL)
1832 {
1833 bfd_byte *dynbuf, *extdyn, *extdynend;
1834 size_t extdynsize;
1835 void (*swap_dyn_in) (bfd *, const void *, Elf_Internal_Dyn *);
1836
1837 if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, dynamic, &dynbuf))
1838 return -1;
1839
1840 extdynsize = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->sizeof_dyn;
1841 swap_dyn_in = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->swap_dyn_in;
1842
1843 extdyn = dynbuf;
1844 extdynend = extdyn + dynamic->size;
1845 for (; extdyn < extdynend; extdyn += extdynsize)
1846 {
1847 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
1848 (*swap_dyn_in) (abfd, extdyn, &dyn);
1849
1850 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_NULL)
1851 break;
1852
1853 if (dyn.d_tag == DT_PPC_GOT)
1854 {
1855 unsigned int g_o_t = dyn.d_un.d_val;
1856 asection *got = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got");
1857 if (got != NULL
1858 && bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, got, buf,
1859 g_o_t - got->vma + 4, 4))
1860 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1861 break;
1862 }
1863 }
1864 free (dynbuf);
1865 }
1866
1867 /* Otherwise we read the first plt entry. */
1868 if (glink_vma == 0)
1869 {
1870 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, plt, buf, 0, 4))
1871 glink_vma = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1872 }
1873
1874 if (glink_vma == 0)
1875 return 0;
1876
1877 /* The .glink section usually does not survive the final
1878 link; search for the section (usually .text) where the
1879 glink stubs now reside. */
1880 glink = bfd_sections_find_if (abfd, section_covers_vma, &glink_vma);
1881 if (glink == NULL)
1882 return 0;
1883
1884 /* Determine glink PLT resolver by reading the relative branch
1885 from the first glink stub. */
1886 if (bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1887 glink_vma - glink->vma, 4))
1888 {
1889 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf);
1890
1891 /* The first glink stub may either branch to the resolver ... */
1892 insn ^= B;
1893 if ((insn & ~0x3fffffc) == 0)
1894 resolv_vma = glink_vma + (insn ^ 0x2000000) - 0x2000000;
1895
1896 /* ... or fall through a bunch of NOPs. */
1897 else if ((insn ^ B ^ NOP) == 0)
1898 for (i = 4;
1899 bfd_get_section_contents (abfd, glink, buf,
1900 glink_vma - glink->vma + i, 4);
1901 i += 4)
1902 if (bfd_get_32 (abfd, buf) != NOP)
1903 {
1904 resolv_vma = glink_vma + i;
1905 break;
1906 }
1907 }
1908
1909 count = relplt->size / sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
1910 /* If the stubs are those for -shared/-pie then we might have
1911 multiple stubs for each plt entry. If that is the case then
1912 there is no way to associate stubs with their plt entries short
1913 of figuring out the GOT pointer value used in the stub.
1914 The offsets tested here need to cover all possible values of
1915 GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE for other than __tls_get_addr_opt. */
1916 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1917 for (stub_delta = 16; stub_delta <= 32; stub_delta += 8)
1918 if (is_nonpic_glink_stub (abfd, glink, stub_off - stub_delta))
1919 break;
1920 if (stub_delta > 32)
1921 return 0;
1922
1923 slurp_relocs = get_elf_backend_data (abfd)->s->slurp_reloc_table;
1924 if (! (*slurp_relocs) (abfd, relplt, dynsyms, TRUE))
1925 return -1;
1926
1927 size = count * sizeof (asymbol);
1928 p = relplt->relocation;
1929 for (i = 0; i < count; i++, p++)
1930 {
1931 size += strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name) + sizeof ("@plt");
1932 if (p->addend != 0)
1933 size += sizeof ("+0x") - 1 + 8;
1934 }
1935
1936 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink");
1937
1938 if (resolv_vma)
1939 size += sizeof (asymbol) + sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
1940
1941 s = *ret = bfd_malloc (size);
1942 if (s == NULL)
1943 return -1;
1944
1945 stub_off = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1946 names = (char *) (s + count + 1 + (resolv_vma != 0));
1947 p = relplt->relocation + count - 1;
1948 for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
1949 {
1950 size_t len;
1951
1952 stub_off -= stub_delta;
1953 if (strcmp ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, "__tls_get_addr_opt") == 0)
1954 stub_off -= 32;
1955 *s = **p->sym_ptr_ptr;
1956 /* Undefined syms won't have BSF_LOCAL or BSF_GLOBAL set. Since
1957 we are defining a symbol, ensure one of them is set. */
1958 if ((s->flags & BSF_LOCAL) == 0)
1959 s->flags |= BSF_GLOBAL;
1960 s->flags |= BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1961 s->section = glink;
1962 s->value = stub_off;
1963 s->name = names;
1964 s->udata.p = NULL;
1965 len = strlen ((*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name);
1966 memcpy (names, (*p->sym_ptr_ptr)->name, len);
1967 names += len;
1968 if (p->addend != 0)
1969 {
1970 memcpy (names, "+0x", sizeof ("+0x") - 1);
1971 names += sizeof ("+0x") - 1;
1972 bfd_sprintf_vma (abfd, names, p->addend);
1973 names += strlen (names);
1974 }
1975 memcpy (names, "@plt", sizeof ("@plt"));
1976 names += sizeof ("@plt");
1977 ++s;
1978 --p;
1979 }
1980
1981 /* Add a symbol at the start of the glink branch table. */
1982 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1983 s->the_bfd = abfd;
1984 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1985 s->section = glink;
1986 s->value = glink_vma - glink->vma;
1987 s->name = names;
1988 memcpy (names, "__glink", sizeof ("__glink"));
1989 names += sizeof ("__glink");
1990 s++;
1991 count++;
1992
1993 if (resolv_vma)
1994 {
1995 /* Add a symbol for the glink PLT resolver. */
1996 memset (s, 0, sizeof *s);
1997 s->the_bfd = abfd;
1998 s->flags = BSF_GLOBAL | BSF_SYNTHETIC;
1999 s->section = glink;
2000 s->value = resolv_vma - glink->vma;
2001 s->name = names;
2002 memcpy (names, "__glink_PLTresolve", sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve"));
2003 names += sizeof ("__glink_PLTresolve");
2004 s++;
2005 count++;
2006 }
2007
2008 return count;
2009 }
2010 \f
2011 /* The following functions are specific to the ELF linker, while
2012 functions above are used generally. They appear in this file more
2013 or less in the order in which they are called. eg.
2014 ppc_elf_check_relocs is called early in the link process,
2015 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections is one of the last functions
2016 called. */
2017
2018 /* Track PLT entries needed for a given symbol. We might need more
2019 than one glink entry per symbol when generating a pic binary. */
2020 struct plt_entry
2021 {
2022 struct plt_entry *next;
2023
2024 /* -fPIC uses multiple GOT sections, one per file, called ".got2".
2025 This field stores the offset into .got2 used to initialise the
2026 GOT pointer reg. It will always be at least 32768. (Current
2027 gcc always uses an offset of 32768, but ld -r will pack .got2
2028 sections together resulting in larger offsets). */
2029 bfd_vma addend;
2030
2031 /* The .got2 section. */
2032 asection *sec;
2033
2034 /* PLT refcount or offset. */
2035 union
2036 {
2037 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2038 bfd_vma offset;
2039 } plt;
2040
2041 /* .glink stub offset. */
2042 bfd_vma glink_offset;
2043 };
2044
2045 /* Of those relocs that might be copied as dynamic relocs, this
2046 function selects those that must be copied when linking a shared
2047 library or PIE, even when the symbol is local. */
2048
2049 static int
2050 must_be_dyn_reloc (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2051 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2052 {
2053 switch (r_type)
2054 {
2055 default:
2056 /* Only relative relocs can be resolved when the object load
2057 address isn't fixed. DTPREL32 is excluded because the
2058 dynamic linker needs to differentiate global dynamic from
2059 local dynamic __tls_index pairs when PPC_OPT_TLS is set. */
2060 return 1;
2061
2062 case R_PPC_REL24:
2063 case R_PPC_REL14:
2064 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
2065 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
2066 case R_PPC_REL32:
2067 return 0;
2068
2069 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
2070 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
2071 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
2072 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
2073 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
2074 /* These relocations are relative but in a shared library the
2075 linker doesn't know the thread pointer base. */
2076 return bfd_link_dll (info);
2077 }
2078 }
2079
2080 /* If ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS is non-zero, the linker will try to avoid
2081 copying dynamic variables from a shared lib into an app's dynbss
2082 section, and instead use a dynamic relocation to point into the
2083 shared lib. */
2084 #define ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS 1
2085
2086 /* Used to track dynamic relocations for local symbols. */
2087 struct ppc_dyn_relocs
2088 {
2089 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *next;
2090
2091 /* The input section of the reloc. */
2092 asection *sec;
2093
2094 /* Total number of relocs copied for the input section. */
2095 unsigned int count : 31;
2096
2097 /* Whether this entry is for STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols. */
2098 unsigned int ifunc : 1;
2099 };
2100
2101 /* PPC ELF linker hash entry. */
2102
2103 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry
2104 {
2105 struct elf_link_hash_entry elf;
2106
2107 /* If this symbol is used in the linker created sections, the processor
2108 specific backend uses this field to map the field into the offset
2109 from the beginning of the section. */
2110 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_pointer;
2111
2112 /* Track dynamic relocs copied for this symbol. */
2113 struct elf_dyn_relocs *dyn_relocs;
2114
2115 /* Contexts in which symbol is used in the GOT.
2116 Bits are or'd into the mask as the corresponding relocs are
2117 encountered during check_relocs, with TLS_TLS being set when any
2118 of the other TLS bits are set. tls_optimize clears bits when
2119 optimizing to indicate the corresponding GOT entry type is not
2120 needed. If set, TLS_TLS is never cleared. tls_optimize may also
2121 set TLS_GDIE when a GD reloc turns into an IE one.
2122 These flags are also kept for local symbols. */
2123 #define TLS_TLS 1 /* Any TLS reloc. */
2124 #define TLS_GD 2 /* GD reloc. */
2125 #define TLS_LD 4 /* LD reloc. */
2126 #define TLS_TPREL 8 /* TPREL reloc, => IE. */
2127 #define TLS_DTPREL 16 /* DTPREL reloc, => LD. */
2128 #define TLS_MARK 32 /* __tls_get_addr call marked. */
2129 #define TLS_GDIE 64 /* GOT TPREL reloc resulting from GD->IE. */
2130 unsigned char tls_mask;
2131
2132 /* The above field is also used to mark function symbols. In which
2133 case TLS_TLS will be 0. */
2134 #define PLT_IFUNC 2 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC. */
2135 #define PLT_KEEP 4 /* inline plt call requires plt entry. */
2136 #define NON_GOT 256 /* local symbol plt, not stored. */
2137
2138 /* Nonzero if we have seen a small data relocation referring to this
2139 symbol. */
2140 unsigned char has_sda_refs : 1;
2141
2142 /* Flag use of given relocations. */
2143 unsigned char has_addr16_ha : 1;
2144 unsigned char has_addr16_lo : 1;
2145 };
2146
2147 #define ppc_elf_hash_entry(ent) ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) (ent))
2148
2149 /* PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2150
2151 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table
2152 {
2153 struct elf_link_hash_table elf;
2154
2155 /* Various options passed from the linker. */
2156 struct ppc_elf_params *params;
2157
2158 /* Short-cuts to get to dynamic linker sections. */
2159 asection *glink;
2160 asection *dynsbss;
2161 asection *relsbss;
2162 elf_linker_section_t sdata[2];
2163 asection *sbss;
2164 asection *glink_eh_frame;
2165 asection *pltlocal;
2166 asection *relpltlocal;
2167
2168 /* The (unloaded but important) .rela.plt.unloaded on VxWorks. */
2169 asection *srelplt2;
2170
2171 /* Shortcut to __tls_get_addr. */
2172 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tls_get_addr;
2173
2174 /* The bfd that forced an old-style PLT. */
2175 bfd *old_bfd;
2176
2177 /* TLS local dynamic got entry handling. */
2178 union {
2179 bfd_signed_vma refcount;
2180 bfd_vma offset;
2181 } tlsld_got;
2182
2183 /* Offset of branch table to PltResolve function in glink. */
2184 bfd_vma glink_pltresolve;
2185
2186 /* Size of reserved GOT entries. */
2187 unsigned int got_header_size;
2188 /* Non-zero if allocating the header left a gap. */
2189 unsigned int got_gap;
2190
2191 /* The type of PLT we have chosen to use. */
2192 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type;
2193
2194 /* True if the target system is VxWorks. */
2195 unsigned int is_vxworks:1;
2196
2197 /* Whether there exist local gnu indirect function resolvers,
2198 referenced by dynamic relocations. */
2199 unsigned int local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2200 unsigned int maybe_local_ifunc_resolver:1;
2201
2202 /* Set if tls optimization is enabled. */
2203 unsigned int do_tls_opt:1;
2204
2205 /* Set if inline plt calls should be converted to direct calls. */
2206 unsigned int can_convert_all_inline_plt:1;
2207
2208 /* The size of PLT entries. */
2209 int plt_entry_size;
2210 /* The distance between adjacent PLT slots. */
2211 int plt_slot_size;
2212 /* The size of the first PLT entry. */
2213 int plt_initial_entry_size;
2214
2215 /* Small local sym cache. */
2216 struct sym_cache sym_cache;
2217 };
2218
2219 /* Rename some of the generic section flags to better document how they
2220 are used for ppc32. The flags are only valid for ppc32 elf objects. */
2221
2222 /* Nonzero if this section has TLS related relocations. */
2223 #define has_tls_reloc sec_flg0
2224
2225 /* Nonzero if this section has a call to __tls_get_addr lacking marker
2226 relocs. */
2227 #define nomark_tls_get_addr sec_flg1
2228
2229 /* Flag set when PLTCALL relocs are detected. */
2230 #define has_pltcall sec_flg2
2231
2232 /* Get the PPC ELF linker hash table from a link_info structure. */
2233
2234 #define ppc_elf_hash_table(p) \
2235 (elf_hash_table_id ((struct elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) \
2236 == PPC32_ELF_DATA ? ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *) ((p)->hash)) : NULL)
2237
2238 /* Create an entry in a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2239
2240 static struct bfd_hash_entry *
2241 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc (struct bfd_hash_entry *entry,
2242 struct bfd_hash_table *table,
2243 const char *string)
2244 {
2245 /* Allocate the structure if it has not already been allocated by a
2246 subclass. */
2247 if (entry == NULL)
2248 {
2249 entry = bfd_hash_allocate (table,
2250 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry));
2251 if (entry == NULL)
2252 return entry;
2253 }
2254
2255 /* Call the allocation method of the superclass. */
2256 entry = _bfd_elf_link_hash_newfunc (entry, table, string);
2257 if (entry != NULL)
2258 {
2259 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->linker_section_pointer = NULL;
2260 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2261 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->tls_mask = 0;
2262 ppc_elf_hash_entry (entry)->has_sda_refs = 0;
2263 }
2264
2265 return entry;
2266 }
2267
2268 /* Create a PPC ELF linker hash table. */
2269
2270 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
2271 ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
2272 {
2273 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *ret;
2274 static struct ppc_elf_params default_params
2275 = { PLT_OLD, 0, 0, 1, 0, 0, 12, 0, 0, 0 };
2276
2277 ret = bfd_zmalloc (sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table));
2278 if (ret == NULL)
2279 return NULL;
2280
2281 if (!_bfd_elf_link_hash_table_init (&ret->elf, abfd,
2282 ppc_elf_link_hash_newfunc,
2283 sizeof (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry),
2284 PPC32_ELF_DATA))
2285 {
2286 free (ret);
2287 return NULL;
2288 }
2289
2290 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.refcount = 0;
2291 ret->elf.init_plt_refcount.glist = NULL;
2292 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.offset = 0;
2293 ret->elf.init_plt_offset.glist = NULL;
2294
2295 ret->params = &default_params;
2296
2297 ret->sdata[0].name = ".sdata";
2298 ret->sdata[0].sym_name = "_SDA_BASE_";
2299 ret->sdata[0].bss_name = ".sbss";
2300
2301 ret->sdata[1].name = ".sdata2";
2302 ret->sdata[1].sym_name = "_SDA2_BASE_";
2303 ret->sdata[1].bss_name = ".sbss2";
2304
2305 ret->plt_entry_size = 12;
2306 ret->plt_slot_size = 8;
2307 ret->plt_initial_entry_size = 72;
2308
2309 return &ret->elf.root;
2310 }
2311
2312 /* Hook linker params into hash table. */
2313
2314 void
2315 ppc_elf_link_params (struct bfd_link_info *info, struct ppc_elf_params *params)
2316 {
2317 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2318
2319 if (htab)
2320 htab->params = params;
2321 params->pagesize_p2 = bfd_log2 (params->pagesize);
2322 }
2323
2324 /* Create .got and the related sections. */
2325
2326 static bfd_boolean
2327 ppc_elf_create_got (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2328 {
2329 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2330
2331 if (!_bfd_elf_create_got_section (abfd, info))
2332 return FALSE;
2333
2334 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2335 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
2336 {
2337 /* The powerpc .got has a blrl instruction in it. Mark it
2338 executable. */
2339 flagword flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2340 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2341 if (!bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
2342 return FALSE;
2343 }
2344
2345 return TRUE;
2346 }
2347
2348 /* Create a special linker section, used for R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16 and
2349 R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16 pointers. These sections become part of .sdata
2350 and .sdata2. Create _SDA_BASE_ and _SDA2_BASE too. */
2351
2352 static bfd_boolean
2353 ppc_elf_create_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2354 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2355 flagword flags,
2356 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2357 {
2358 asection *s;
2359
2360 flags |= (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY
2361 | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2362
2363 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, lsect->name, flags);
2364 if (s == NULL)
2365 return FALSE;
2366 lsect->section = s;
2367
2368 /* Define the sym on the first section of this name. */
2369 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, lsect->name);
2370
2371 lsect->sym = _bfd_elf_define_linkage_sym (abfd, info, s, lsect->sym_name);
2372 if (lsect->sym == NULL)
2373 return FALSE;
2374 lsect->sym->root.u.def.value = 0x8000;
2375 return TRUE;
2376 }
2377
2378 static bfd_boolean
2379 ppc_elf_create_glink (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2380 {
2381 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2382 asection *s;
2383 flagword flags;
2384 int p2align;
2385
2386 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_CODE | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2387 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2388 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".glink", flags);
2389 htab->glink = s;
2390 p2align = htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 6 : 4;
2391 if (p2align < htab->params->plt_stub_align)
2392 p2align = htab->params->plt_stub_align;
2393 if (s == NULL
2394 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, p2align))
2395 return FALSE;
2396
2397 if (!info->no_ld_generated_unwind_info)
2398 {
2399 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2400 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2401 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".eh_frame", flags);
2402 htab->glink_eh_frame = s;
2403 if (s == NULL
2404 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2405 return FALSE;
2406 }
2407
2408 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2409 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".iplt", flags);
2410 htab->elf.iplt = s;
2411 if (s == NULL
2412 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 4))
2413 return FALSE;
2414
2415 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2416 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2417 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.iplt", flags);
2418 htab->elf.irelplt = s;
2419 if (s == NULL
2420 || ! bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2421 return FALSE;
2422
2423 /* Local plt entries. */
2424 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD
2425 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2426 htab->pltlocal = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".branch_lt",
2427 flags);
2428 if (htab->pltlocal == NULL
2429 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->pltlocal, 2))
2430 return FALSE;
2431
2432 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
2433 {
2434 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY
2435 | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2436 htab->relpltlocal
2437 = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.branch_lt", flags);
2438 if (htab->relpltlocal == NULL
2439 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->relpltlocal, 2))
2440 return FALSE;
2441 }
2442
2443 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, 0,
2444 &htab->sdata[0]))
2445 return FALSE;
2446
2447 if (!ppc_elf_create_linker_section (abfd, info, SEC_READONLY,
2448 &htab->sdata[1]))
2449 return FALSE;
2450
2451 return TRUE;
2452 }
2453
2454 /* We have to create .dynsbss and .rela.sbss here so that they get mapped
2455 to output sections (just like _bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections has
2456 to create .dynbss and .rela.bss). */
2457
2458 static bfd_boolean
2459 ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections (bfd *abfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
2460 {
2461 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2462 asection *s;
2463 flagword flags;
2464
2465 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2466
2467 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2468 && !ppc_elf_create_got (abfd, info))
2469 return FALSE;
2470
2471 if (!_bfd_elf_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info))
2472 return FALSE;
2473
2474 if (htab->glink == NULL
2475 && !ppc_elf_create_glink (abfd, info))
2476 return FALSE;
2477
2478 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".dynsbss",
2479 SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2480 htab->dynsbss = s;
2481 if (s == NULL)
2482 return FALSE;
2483
2484 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
2485 {
2486 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
2487 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
2488 s = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (abfd, ".rela.sbss", flags);
2489 htab->relsbss = s;
2490 if (s == NULL
2491 || !bfd_set_section_alignment (s, 2))
2492 return FALSE;
2493 }
2494
2495 if (htab->is_vxworks
2496 && !elf_vxworks_create_dynamic_sections (abfd, info, &htab->srelplt2))
2497 return FALSE;
2498
2499 s = htab->elf.splt;
2500 flags = SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2501 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
2502 /* The VxWorks PLT is a loaded section with contents. */
2503 flags |= SEC_HAS_CONTENTS | SEC_LOAD | SEC_READONLY;
2504 return bfd_set_section_flags (s, flags);
2505 }
2506
2507 /* Copy the extra info we tack onto an elf_link_hash_entry. */
2508
2509 static void
2510 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
2511 struct elf_link_hash_entry *dir,
2512 struct elf_link_hash_entry *ind)
2513 {
2514 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *edir, *eind;
2515
2516 edir = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) dir;
2517 eind = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) ind;
2518
2519 edir->tls_mask |= eind->tls_mask;
2520 edir->has_sda_refs |= eind->has_sda_refs;
2521
2522 if (edir->elf.versioned != versioned_hidden)
2523 edir->elf.ref_dynamic |= eind->elf.ref_dynamic;
2524 edir->elf.ref_regular |= eind->elf.ref_regular;
2525 edir->elf.ref_regular_nonweak |= eind->elf.ref_regular_nonweak;
2526 edir->elf.non_got_ref |= eind->elf.non_got_ref;
2527 edir->elf.needs_plt |= eind->elf.needs_plt;
2528 edir->elf.pointer_equality_needed |= eind->elf.pointer_equality_needed;
2529
2530 /* If we were called to copy over info for a weak sym, that's all. */
2531 if (eind->elf.root.type != bfd_link_hash_indirect)
2532 return;
2533
2534 if (eind->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2535 {
2536 if (edir->dyn_relocs != NULL)
2537 {
2538 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
2539 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
2540
2541 /* Add reloc counts against the indirect sym to the direct sym
2542 list. Merge any entries against the same section. */
2543 for (pp = &eind->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
2544 {
2545 struct elf_dyn_relocs *q;
2546
2547 for (q = edir->dyn_relocs; q != NULL; q = q->next)
2548 if (q->sec == p->sec)
2549 {
2550 q->pc_count += p->pc_count;
2551 q->count += p->count;
2552 *pp = p->next;
2553 break;
2554 }
2555 if (q == NULL)
2556 pp = &p->next;
2557 }
2558 *pp = edir->dyn_relocs;
2559 }
2560
2561 edir->dyn_relocs = eind->dyn_relocs;
2562 eind->dyn_relocs = NULL;
2563 }
2564
2565 /* Copy over the GOT refcount entries that we may have already seen to
2566 the symbol which just became indirect. */
2567 edir->elf.got.refcount += eind->elf.got.refcount;
2568 eind->elf.got.refcount = 0;
2569
2570 /* And plt entries. */
2571 if (eind->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2572 {
2573 if (edir->elf.plt.plist != NULL)
2574 {
2575 struct plt_entry **entp;
2576 struct plt_entry *ent;
2577
2578 for (entp = &eind->elf.plt.plist; (ent = *entp) != NULL; )
2579 {
2580 struct plt_entry *dent;
2581
2582 for (dent = edir->elf.plt.plist; dent != NULL; dent = dent->next)
2583 if (dent->sec == ent->sec && dent->addend == ent->addend)
2584 {
2585 dent->plt.refcount += ent->plt.refcount;
2586 *entp = ent->next;
2587 break;
2588 }
2589 if (dent == NULL)
2590 entp = &ent->next;
2591 }
2592 *entp = edir->elf.plt.plist;
2593 }
2594
2595 edir->elf.plt.plist = eind->elf.plt.plist;
2596 eind->elf.plt.plist = NULL;
2597 }
2598
2599 if (eind->elf.dynindx != -1)
2600 {
2601 if (edir->elf.dynindx != -1)
2602 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
2603 edir->elf.dynstr_index);
2604 edir->elf.dynindx = eind->elf.dynindx;
2605 edir->elf.dynstr_index = eind->elf.dynstr_index;
2606 eind->elf.dynindx = -1;
2607 eind->elf.dynstr_index = 0;
2608 }
2609 }
2610
2611 /* Hook called by the linker routine which adds symbols from an object
2612 file. We use it to put .comm items in .sbss, and not .bss. */
2613
2614 static bfd_boolean
2615 ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
2616 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2617 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
2618 const char **namep ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2619 flagword *flagsp ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
2620 asection **secp,
2621 bfd_vma *valp)
2622 {
2623 if (sym->st_shndx == SHN_COMMON
2624 && !bfd_link_relocatable (info)
2625 && is_ppc_elf (info->output_bfd)
2626 && sym->st_size <= elf_gp_size (abfd))
2627 {
2628 /* Common symbols less than or equal to -G nn bytes are automatically
2629 put into .sbss. */
2630 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2631
2632 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2633 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2634 {
2635 flagword flags = SEC_IS_COMMON | SEC_LINKER_CREATED;
2636
2637 if (!htab->elf.dynobj)
2638 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2639
2640 htab->sbss = bfd_make_section_anyway_with_flags (htab->elf.dynobj,
2641 ".sbss",
2642 flags);
2643 if (htab->sbss == NULL)
2644 return FALSE;
2645 }
2646
2647 *secp = htab->sbss;
2648 *valp = sym->st_size;
2649 }
2650
2651 return TRUE;
2652 }
2653 \f
2654 /* Find a linker generated pointer with a given addend and type. */
2655
2656 static elf_linker_section_pointers_t *
2657 elf_find_pointer_linker_section
2658 (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_pointers,
2659 bfd_vma addend,
2660 elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
2661 {
2662 for ( ; linker_pointers != NULL; linker_pointers = linker_pointers->next)
2663 if (lsect == linker_pointers->lsect && addend == linker_pointers->addend)
2664 return linker_pointers;
2665
2666 return NULL;
2667 }
2668
2669 /* Allocate a pointer to live in a linker created section. */
2670
2671 static bfd_boolean
2672 elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (bfd *abfd,
2673 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
2674 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
2675 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
2676 {
2677 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr_linker_section_ptr = NULL;
2678 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
2679 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2680 bfd_size_type amt;
2681
2682 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
2683
2684 /* Is this a global symbol? */
2685 if (h != NULL)
2686 {
2687 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
2688
2689 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2690 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
2691 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (eh->linker_section_pointer,
2692 rel->r_addend,
2693 lsect))
2694 return TRUE;
2695
2696 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &eh->linker_section_pointer;
2697 }
2698 else
2699 {
2700 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2701
2702 /* Allocation of a pointer to a local symbol. */
2703 elf_linker_section_pointers_t **ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd);
2704
2705 /* Allocate a table to hold the local symbols if first time. */
2706 if (!ptr)
2707 {
2708 unsigned int num_symbols = elf_symtab_hdr (abfd).sh_info;
2709
2710 amt = num_symbols;
2711 amt *= sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t *);
2712 ptr = bfd_zalloc (abfd, amt);
2713
2714 if (!ptr)
2715 return FALSE;
2716
2717 elf_local_ptr_offsets (abfd) = ptr;
2718 }
2719
2720 /* Has this symbol already been allocated? If so, our work is done. */
2721 if (elf_find_pointer_linker_section (ptr[r_symndx],
2722 rel->r_addend,
2723 lsect))
2724 return TRUE;
2725
2726 ptr_linker_section_ptr = &ptr[r_symndx];
2727 }
2728
2729 /* Allocate space for a pointer in the linker section, and allocate
2730 a new pointer record from internal memory. */
2731 BFD_ASSERT (ptr_linker_section_ptr != NULL);
2732 amt = sizeof (elf_linker_section_pointers_t);
2733 linker_section_ptr = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2734
2735 if (!linker_section_ptr)
2736 return FALSE;
2737
2738 linker_section_ptr->next = *ptr_linker_section_ptr;
2739 linker_section_ptr->addend = rel->r_addend;
2740 linker_section_ptr->lsect = lsect;
2741 *ptr_linker_section_ptr = linker_section_ptr;
2742
2743 if (!bfd_set_section_alignment (lsect->section, 2))
2744 return FALSE;
2745 linker_section_ptr->offset = lsect->section->size;
2746 lsect->section->size += 4;
2747
2748 #ifdef DEBUG
2749 fprintf (stderr,
2750 "Create pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld, section size = %ld\n",
2751 lsect->name, (long) linker_section_ptr->offset,
2752 (long) lsect->section->size);
2753 #endif
2754
2755 return TRUE;
2756 }
2757
2758 static struct plt_entry **
2759 update_local_sym_info (bfd *abfd,
2760 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr,
2761 unsigned long r_symndx,
2762 int tls_type)
2763 {
2764 bfd_signed_vma *local_got_refcounts = elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd);
2765 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
2766 unsigned char *local_got_tls_masks;
2767
2768 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2769 {
2770 bfd_size_type size = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
2771
2772 size *= (sizeof (*local_got_refcounts)
2773 + sizeof (*local_plt)
2774 + sizeof (*local_got_tls_masks));
2775 local_got_refcounts = bfd_zalloc (abfd, size);
2776 if (local_got_refcounts == NULL)
2777 return NULL;
2778 elf_local_got_refcounts (abfd) = local_got_refcounts;
2779 }
2780
2781 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_refcounts + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2782 local_got_tls_masks = (unsigned char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
2783 local_got_tls_masks[r_symndx] |= tls_type & 0xff;
2784 if ((tls_type & NON_GOT) == 0)
2785 local_got_refcounts[r_symndx] += 1;
2786 return local_plt + r_symndx;
2787 }
2788
2789 static bfd_boolean
2790 update_plt_info (bfd *abfd, struct plt_entry **plist,
2791 asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2792 {
2793 struct plt_entry *ent;
2794
2795 if (addend < 32768)
2796 sec = NULL;
2797 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2798 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2799 break;
2800 if (ent == NULL)
2801 {
2802 bfd_size_type amt = sizeof (*ent);
2803 ent = bfd_alloc (abfd, amt);
2804 if (ent == NULL)
2805 return FALSE;
2806 ent->next = *plist;
2807 ent->sec = sec;
2808 ent->addend = addend;
2809 ent->plt.refcount = 0;
2810 *plist = ent;
2811 }
2812 ent->plt.refcount += 1;
2813 return TRUE;
2814 }
2815
2816 static struct plt_entry *
2817 find_plt_ent (struct plt_entry **plist, asection *sec, bfd_vma addend)
2818 {
2819 struct plt_entry *ent;
2820
2821 if (addend < 32768)
2822 sec = NULL;
2823 for (ent = *plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
2824 if (ent->sec == sec && ent->addend == addend)
2825 break;
2826 return ent;
2827 }
2828
2829 static bfd_boolean
2830 is_branch_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2831 {
2832 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2833 || r_type == R_PPC_LOCAL24PC
2834 || r_type == R_PPC_REL24
2835 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14
2836 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
2837 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN
2838 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR24
2839 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14
2840 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN
2841 || r_type == R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN
2842 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_REL24);
2843 }
2844
2845 /* Relocs on inline plt call sequence insns prior to the call. */
2846
2847 static bfd_boolean
2848 is_plt_seq_reloc (enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2849 {
2850 return (r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA
2851 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2852 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2853 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTSEQ);
2854 }
2855
2856 static void
2857 bad_shared_reloc (bfd *abfd, enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type)
2858 {
2859 _bfd_error_handler
2860 /* xgettext:c-format */
2861 (_("%pB: relocation %s cannot be used when making a shared object"),
2862 abfd,
2863 ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type]->name);
2864 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
2865 }
2866
2867 /* Look through the relocs for a section during the first phase, and
2868 allocate space in the global offset table or procedure linkage
2869 table. */
2870
2871 static bfd_boolean
2872 ppc_elf_check_relocs (bfd *abfd,
2873 struct bfd_link_info *info,
2874 asection *sec,
2875 const Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs)
2876 {
2877 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
2878 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
2879 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
2880 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
2881 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel_end;
2882 asection *got2, *sreloc;
2883 struct elf_link_hash_entry *tga;
2884
2885 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
2886 return TRUE;
2887
2888 /* Don't do anything special with non-loaded, non-alloced sections.
2889 In particular, any relocs in such sections should not affect GOT
2890 and PLT reference counting (ie. we don't allow them to create GOT
2891 or PLT entries), there's no possibility or desire to optimize TLS
2892 relocs, and there's not much point in propagating relocs to shared
2893 libs that the dynamic linker won't relocate. */
2894 if ((sec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0)
2895 return TRUE;
2896
2897 #ifdef DEBUG
2898 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_check_relocs called for section %pA in %pB",
2899 sec, abfd);
2900 #endif
2901
2902 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (abfd));
2903
2904 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
2905 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
2906 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
2907
2908 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
2909 if (htab->glink == NULL)
2910 {
2911 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2912 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2913 if (!ppc_elf_create_glink (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2914 return FALSE;
2915 }
2916 tga = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
2917 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
2918 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
2919 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (abfd);
2920 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
2921 sreloc = NULL;
2922
2923 rel_end = relocs + sec->reloc_count;
2924 for (rel = relocs; rel < rel_end; rel++)
2925 {
2926 unsigned long r_symndx;
2927 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
2928 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
2929 int tls_type;
2930 struct plt_entry **ifunc;
2931 struct plt_entry **pltent;
2932 bfd_vma addend;
2933
2934 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
2935 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
2936 h = NULL;
2937 else
2938 {
2939 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
2940 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
2941 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
2942 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
2943 }
2944
2945 /* If a relocation refers to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_, create the .got.
2946 This shows up in particular in an R_PPC_ADDR32 in the eabi
2947 startup code. */
2948 if (h != NULL
2949 && htab->elf.sgot == NULL
2950 && strcmp (h->root.root.string, "_GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_") == 0)
2951 {
2952 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
2953 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
2954 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
2955 return FALSE;
2956 BFD_ASSERT (h == htab->elf.hgot);
2957 }
2958
2959 tls_type = 0;
2960 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
2961 ifunc = NULL;
2962 if (h == NULL && !htab->is_vxworks)
2963 {
2964 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
2965 abfd, r_symndx);
2966 if (isym == NULL)
2967 return FALSE;
2968
2969 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
2970 {
2971 /* Set PLT_IFUNC flag for this sym, no GOT entry yet. */
2972 ifunc = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
2973 NON_GOT | PLT_IFUNC);
2974 if (ifunc == NULL)
2975 return FALSE;
2976
2977 /* STT_GNU_IFUNC symbols must have a PLT entry;
2978 In a non-pie executable even when there are
2979 no plt calls. */
2980 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
2981 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
2982 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2983 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2984 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA)
2985 {
2986 addend = 0;
2987 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
2988 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
2989 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
2990 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
2991 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
2992 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
2993 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
2994 addend = rel->r_addend;
2995 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, ifunc, got2, addend))
2996 return FALSE;
2997 }
2998 }
2999 }
3000
3001 if (!htab->is_vxworks
3002 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)
3003 && h != NULL
3004 && h == tga)
3005 {
3006 if (rel != relocs
3007 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSGD
3008 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_TLSLD))
3009 /* We have a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a marker
3010 reloc. */
3011 ;
3012 else
3013 /* Mark this section as having an old-style call. */
3014 sec->nomark_tls_get_addr = 1;
3015 }
3016
3017 switch (r_type)
3018 {
3019 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
3020 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
3021 /* These special tls relocs tie a call to __tls_get_addr with
3022 its parameter symbol. */
3023 if (h != NULL)
3024 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK;
3025 else
3026 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3027 NON_GOT | TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
3028 return FALSE;
3029 break;
3030
3031 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
3032 break;
3033
3034 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
3035 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
3036 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
3037 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
3038 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
3039 goto dogottls;
3040
3041 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
3042 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
3043 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
3044 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
3045 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
3046 goto dogottls;
3047
3048 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
3049 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
3050 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
3051 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
3052 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3053 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3054 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
3055 goto dogottls;
3056
3057 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
3058 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
3059 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
3060 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
3061 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
3062 dogottls:
3063 sec->has_tls_reloc = 1;
3064 /* Fall through. */
3065
3066 /* GOT16 relocations */
3067 case R_PPC_GOT16:
3068 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
3069 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
3070 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
3071 /* This symbol requires a global offset table entry. */
3072 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
3073 {
3074 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3075 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3076 if (!ppc_elf_create_got (htab->elf.dynobj, info))
3077 return FALSE;
3078 }
3079 if (h != NULL)
3080 {
3081 h->got.refcount += 1;
3082 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= tls_type;
3083 }
3084 else
3085 /* This is a global offset table entry for a local symbol. */
3086 if (!update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx, tls_type))
3087 return FALSE;
3088
3089 /* We may also need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3090 an ifunc. */
3091 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3092 {
3093 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3094 return FALSE;
3095 }
3096 break;
3097
3098 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
3099 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
3100 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3101 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[0],
3102 h, rel))
3103 return FALSE;
3104 if (h != NULL)
3105 {
3106 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3107 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3108 }
3109 break;
3110
3111 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
3112 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
3113 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3114 {
3115 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3116 return FALSE;
3117 }
3118 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3119 if (!elf_allocate_pointer_linker_section (abfd, &htab->sdata[1],
3120 h, rel))
3121 return FALSE;
3122 if (h != NULL)
3123 {
3124 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3125 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3126 }
3127 break;
3128
3129 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
3130 htab->sdata[0].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3131 /* Fall through. */
3132
3133 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
3134 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
3135 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
3136 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
3137 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
3138 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
3139 if (h != NULL)
3140 {
3141 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3142 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3143 }
3144 break;
3145
3146 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
3147 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
3148 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
3149 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
3150 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
3151 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
3152 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
3153 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
3154 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
3155 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
3156 break;
3157
3158 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
3159 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
3160 {
3161 bad_shared_reloc (abfd, r_type);
3162 return FALSE;
3163 }
3164 htab->sdata[1].sym->ref_regular = 1;
3165 if (h != NULL)
3166 {
3167 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3168 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3169 }
3170 break;
3171
3172 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
3173 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
3174 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
3175 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
3176 if (h != NULL)
3177 {
3178 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs = TRUE;
3179 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3180 }
3181 break;
3182
3183 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
3184 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
3185 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
3186 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
3187 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
3188 if (h != NULL)
3189 h->non_got_ref = TRUE;
3190 break;
3191
3192 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
3193 if (h == NULL)
3194 break;
3195 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->makes_plt_call = 1;
3196 goto pltentry;
3197
3198 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
3199 sec->has_pltcall = 1;
3200 /* Fall through. */
3201
3202 case R_PPC_PLT32:
3203 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
3204 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
3205 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
3206 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
3207 pltentry:
3208 #ifdef DEBUG
3209 fprintf (stderr, "Reloc requires a PLT entry\n");
3210 #endif
3211 /* This symbol requires a procedure linkage table entry. */
3212 if (h == NULL)
3213 {
3214 pltent = update_local_sym_info (abfd, symtab_hdr, r_symndx,
3215 NON_GOT | PLT_KEEP);
3216 if (pltent == NULL)
3217 return FALSE;
3218 }
3219 else
3220 {
3221 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
3222 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask |= PLT_KEEP;
3223 h->needs_plt = 1;
3224 pltent = &h->plt.plist;
3225 }
3226 addend = 0;
3227 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3228 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
3229 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
3230 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
3231 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
3232 addend = rel->r_addend;
3233 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, pltent, got2, addend))
3234 return FALSE;
3235 break;
3236
3237 /* The following relocations don't need to propagate the
3238 relocation if linking a shared object since they are
3239 section relative. */
3240 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
3241 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
3242 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
3243 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
3244 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
3245 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
3246 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
3247 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
3248 case R_PPC_TOC16:
3249 break;
3250
3251 case R_PPC_REL16:
3252 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
3253 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
3254 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
3255 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
3256 ppc_elf_tdata (abfd)->has_rel16 = 1;
3257 break;
3258
3259 /* These are just markers. */
3260 case R_PPC_TLS:
3261 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
3262 case R_PPC_NONE:
3263 case R_PPC_max:
3264 case R_PPC_RELAX:
3265 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
3266 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
3267 case R_PPC_16DX_HA:
3268 break;
3269
3270 /* These should only appear in dynamic objects. */
3271 case R_PPC_COPY:
3272 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
3273 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
3274 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
3275 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
3276 break;
3277
3278 /* These aren't handled yet. We'll report an error later. */
3279 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
3280 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
3281 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
3282 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
3283 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
3284 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
3285 break;
3286
3287 /* This refers only to functions defined in the shared library. */
3288 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
3289 if (h != NULL && h == htab->elf.hgot && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3290 {
3291 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3292 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3293 }
3294 if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
3295 {
3296 h->needs_plt = 1;
3297 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3298 return FALSE;
3299 }
3300 break;
3301
3302 /* This relocation describes the C++ object vtable hierarchy.
3303 Reconstruct it for later use during GC. */
3304 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
3305 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtinherit (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_offset))
3306 return FALSE;
3307 break;
3308
3309 /* This relocation describes which C++ vtable entries are actually
3310 used. Record for later use during GC. */
3311 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
3312 if (!bfd_elf_gc_record_vtentry (abfd, sec, h, rel->r_addend))
3313 return FALSE;
3314 break;
3315
3316 /* We shouldn't really be seeing TPREL32. */
3317 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
3318 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
3319 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
3320 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
3321 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
3322 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
3323 info->flags |= DF_STATIC_TLS;
3324 goto dodyn;
3325
3326 /* Nor these. */
3327 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
3328 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
3329 goto dodyn;
3330
3331 case R_PPC_REL32:
3332 if (h == NULL
3333 && got2 != NULL
3334 && (sec->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0
3335 && bfd_link_pic (info)
3336 && htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3337 {
3338 /* Old -fPIC gcc code has .long LCTOC1-LCFx just before
3339 the start of a function, which assembles to a REL32
3340 reference to .got2. If we detect one of these, then
3341 force the old PLT layout because the linker cannot
3342 reliably deduce the GOT pointer value needed for
3343 PLT call stubs. */
3344 asection *s;
3345 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3346
3347 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3348 abfd, r_symndx);
3349 if (isym == NULL)
3350 return FALSE;
3351
3352 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3353 if (s == got2)
3354 {
3355 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3356 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3357 }
3358 }
3359 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
3360 break;
3361 /* fall through */
3362
3363 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
3364 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
3365 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
3366 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
3367 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
3368 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
3369 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
3370 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3371 {
3372 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3373 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3374 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3375 return FALSE;
3376
3377 /* We may need a copy reloc too. */
3378 h->non_got_ref = 1;
3379 h->pointer_equality_needed = 1;
3380 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
3381 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha = 1;
3382 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
3383 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo = 1;
3384 }
3385 goto dodyn;
3386
3387 case R_PPC_REL24:
3388 case R_PPC_REL14:
3389 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
3390 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
3391 if (h == NULL)
3392 break;
3393 if (h == htab->elf.hgot)
3394 {
3395 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3396 {
3397 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3398 htab->old_bfd = abfd;
3399 }
3400 break;
3401 }
3402 /* fall through */
3403
3404 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
3405 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
3406 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
3407 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
3408 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
3409 {
3410 /* We may need a plt entry if the symbol turns out to be
3411 a function defined in a dynamic object. */
3412 h->needs_plt = 1;
3413 if (!update_plt_info (abfd, &h->plt.plist, NULL, 0))
3414 return FALSE;
3415 break;
3416 }
3417
3418 dodyn:
3419 /* If we are creating a shared library, and this is a reloc
3420 against a global symbol, or a non PC relative reloc
3421 against a local symbol, then we need to copy the reloc
3422 into the shared library. However, if we are linking with
3423 -Bsymbolic, we do not need to copy a reloc against a
3424 global symbol which is defined in an object we are
3425 including in the link (i.e., DEF_REGULAR is set). At
3426 this point we have not seen all the input files, so it is
3427 possible that DEF_REGULAR is not set now but will be set
3428 later (it is never cleared). In case of a weak definition,
3429 DEF_REGULAR may be cleared later by a strong definition in
3430 a shared library. We account for that possibility below by
3431 storing information in the dyn_relocs field of the hash
3432 table entry. A similar situation occurs when creating
3433 shared libraries and symbol visibility changes render the
3434 symbol local.
3435
3436 If on the other hand, we are creating an executable, we
3437 may need to keep relocations for symbols satisfied by a
3438 dynamic library if we manage to avoid copy relocs for the
3439 symbol. */
3440 if ((bfd_link_pic (info)
3441 && (must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)
3442 || (h != NULL
3443 && (!SYMBOLIC_BIND (info, h)
3444 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3445 || !h->def_regular))))
3446 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
3447 && !bfd_link_pic (info)
3448 && h != NULL
3449 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak
3450 || !h->def_regular)))
3451 {
3452 #ifdef DEBUG
3453 fprintf (stderr,
3454 "ppc_elf_check_relocs needs to "
3455 "create relocation for %s\n",
3456 (h && h->root.root.string
3457 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
3458 #endif
3459 if (sreloc == NULL)
3460 {
3461 if (htab->elf.dynobj == NULL)
3462 htab->elf.dynobj = abfd;
3463
3464 sreloc = _bfd_elf_make_dynamic_reloc_section
3465 (sec, htab->elf.dynobj, 2, abfd, /*rela?*/ TRUE);
3466
3467 if (sreloc == NULL)
3468 return FALSE;
3469 }
3470
3471 /* If this is a global symbol, we count the number of
3472 relocations we need for this symbol. */
3473 if (h != NULL)
3474 {
3475 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
3476 struct elf_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3477
3478 rel_head = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs;
3479 p = *rel_head;
3480 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec)
3481 {
3482 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3483 if (p == NULL)
3484 return FALSE;
3485 p->next = *rel_head;
3486 *rel_head = p;
3487 p->sec = sec;
3488 p->count = 0;
3489 p->pc_count = 0;
3490 }
3491 p->count += 1;
3492 if (!must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type))
3493 p->pc_count += 1;
3494 }
3495 else
3496 {
3497 /* Track dynamic relocs needed for local syms too.
3498 We really need local syms available to do this
3499 easily. Oh well. */
3500 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
3501 struct ppc_dyn_relocs **rel_head;
3502 bfd_boolean is_ifunc;
3503 asection *s;
3504 void *vpp;
3505 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
3506
3507 isym = bfd_sym_from_r_symndx (&htab->sym_cache,
3508 abfd, r_symndx);
3509 if (isym == NULL)
3510 return FALSE;
3511
3512 s = bfd_section_from_elf_index (abfd, isym->st_shndx);
3513 if (s == NULL)
3514 s = sec;
3515
3516 vpp = &elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel;
3517 rel_head = (struct ppc_dyn_relocs **) vpp;
3518 is_ifunc = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC;
3519 p = *rel_head;
3520 if (p != NULL && p->sec == sec && p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3521 p = p->next;
3522 if (p == NULL || p->sec != sec || p->ifunc != is_ifunc)
3523 {
3524 p = bfd_alloc (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof *p);
3525 if (p == NULL)
3526 return FALSE;
3527 p->next = *rel_head;
3528 *rel_head = p;
3529 p->sec = sec;
3530 p->ifunc = is_ifunc;
3531 p->count = 0;
3532 }
3533 p->count += 1;
3534 }
3535 }
3536
3537 break;
3538 }
3539 }
3540
3541 return TRUE;
3542 }
3543 \f
3544 /* Warn for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP attributes between IBFD
3545 and OBFD, and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3546 bfd_boolean
3547 _bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3548 {
3549 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3550 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3551 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3552 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
3553
3554 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3555 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3556
3557 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3558 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_FP];
3559
3560 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3561 {
3562 int in_fp = in_attr->i & 3;
3563 int out_fp = out_attr->i & 3;
3564 static bfd *last_fp, *last_ld;
3565
3566 if (in_fp == 0)
3567 ;
3568 else if (out_fp == 0)
3569 {
3570 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3571 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3572 last_fp = ibfd;
3573 }
3574 else if (out_fp != 2 && in_fp == 2)
3575 {
3576 _bfd_error_handler
3577 /* xgettext:c-format */
3578 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3579 last_fp, ibfd);
3580 ret = FALSE;
3581 }
3582 else if (out_fp == 2 && in_fp != 2)
3583 {
3584 _bfd_error_handler
3585 /* xgettext:c-format */
3586 (_("%pB uses hard float, %pB uses soft float"),
3587 ibfd, last_fp);
3588 ret = FALSE;
3589 }
3590 else if (out_fp == 1 && in_fp == 3)
3591 {
3592 _bfd_error_handler
3593 /* xgettext:c-format */
3594 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3595 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), last_fp, ibfd);
3596 ret = FALSE;
3597 }
3598 else if (out_fp == 3 && in_fp == 1)
3599 {
3600 _bfd_error_handler
3601 /* xgettext:c-format */
3602 (_("%pB uses double-precision hard float, "
3603 "%pB uses single-precision hard float"), ibfd, last_fp);
3604 ret = FALSE;
3605 }
3606
3607 in_fp = in_attr->i & 0xc;
3608 out_fp = out_attr->i & 0xc;
3609 if (in_fp == 0)
3610 ;
3611 else if (out_fp == 0)
3612 {
3613 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3614 out_attr->i ^= in_fp;
3615 last_ld = ibfd;
3616 }
3617 else if (out_fp != 2 * 4 && in_fp == 2 * 4)
3618 {
3619 _bfd_error_handler
3620 /* xgettext:c-format */
3621 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3622 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3623 ret = FALSE;
3624 }
3625 else if (in_fp != 2 * 4 && out_fp == 2 * 4)
3626 {
3627 _bfd_error_handler
3628 /* xgettext:c-format */
3629 (_("%pB uses 64-bit long double, "
3630 "%pB uses 128-bit long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3631 ret = FALSE;
3632 }
3633 else if (out_fp == 1 * 4 && in_fp == 3 * 4)
3634 {
3635 _bfd_error_handler
3636 /* xgettext:c-format */
3637 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3638 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), last_ld, ibfd);
3639 ret = FALSE;
3640 }
3641 else if (out_fp == 3 * 4 && in_fp == 1 * 4)
3642 {
3643 _bfd_error_handler
3644 /* xgettext:c-format */
3645 (_("%pB uses IBM long double, "
3646 "%pB uses IEEE long double"), ibfd, last_ld);
3647 ret = FALSE;
3648 }
3649 }
3650
3651 if (!ret)
3652 {
3653 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3654 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3655 }
3656 return ret;
3657 }
3658
3659 /* Merge object attributes from IBFD into OBFD. Warn if
3660 there are conflicting attributes. */
3661 static bfd_boolean
3662 ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3663 {
3664 bfd *obfd;
3665 obj_attribute *in_attr, *in_attrs;
3666 obj_attribute *out_attr, *out_attrs;
3667 bfd_boolean ret;
3668
3669 if (!_bfd_elf_ppc_merge_fp_attributes (ibfd, info))
3670 return FALSE;
3671
3672 obfd = info->output_bfd;
3673 in_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (ibfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3674 out_attrs = elf_known_obj_attributes (obfd)[OBJ_ATTR_GNU];
3675
3676 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector attributes and
3677 merge non-conflicting ones. */
3678 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3679 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Vector];
3680 ret = TRUE;
3681 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3682 {
3683 int in_vec = in_attr->i & 3;
3684 int out_vec = out_attr->i & 3;
3685 static bfd *last_vec;
3686
3687 if (in_vec == 0)
3688 ;
3689 else if (out_vec == 0)
3690 {
3691 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3692 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3693 last_vec = ibfd;
3694 }
3695 /* For now, allow generic to transition to AltiVec or SPE
3696 without a warning. If GCC marked files with their stack
3697 alignment and used don't-care markings for files which are
3698 not affected by the vector ABI, we could warn about this
3699 case too. */
3700 else if (in_vec == 1)
3701 ;
3702 else if (out_vec == 1)
3703 {
3704 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3705 out_attr->i = in_vec;
3706 last_vec = ibfd;
3707 }
3708 else if (out_vec < in_vec)
3709 {
3710 _bfd_error_handler
3711 /* xgettext:c-format */
3712 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3713 last_vec, ibfd);
3714 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3715 ret = FALSE;
3716 }
3717 else if (out_vec > in_vec)
3718 {
3719 _bfd_error_handler
3720 /* xgettext:c-format */
3721 (_("%pB uses AltiVec vector ABI, %pB uses SPE vector ABI"),
3722 ibfd, last_vec);
3723 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3724 ret = FALSE;
3725 }
3726 }
3727
3728 /* Check for conflicting Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return attributes
3729 and merge non-conflicting ones. */
3730 in_attr = &in_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3731 out_attr = &out_attrs[Tag_GNU_Power_ABI_Struct_Return];
3732 if (in_attr->i != out_attr->i)
3733 {
3734 int in_struct = in_attr->i & 3;
3735 int out_struct = out_attr->i & 3;
3736 static bfd *last_struct;
3737
3738 if (in_struct == 0 || in_struct == 3)
3739 ;
3740 else if (out_struct == 0)
3741 {
3742 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL;
3743 out_attr->i = in_struct;
3744 last_struct = ibfd;
3745 }
3746 else if (out_struct < in_struct)
3747 {
3748 _bfd_error_handler
3749 /* xgettext:c-format */
3750 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3751 "%pB uses memory"), last_struct, ibfd);
3752 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3753 ret = FALSE;
3754 }
3755 else if (out_struct > in_struct)
3756 {
3757 _bfd_error_handler
3758 /* xgettext:c-format */
3759 (_("%pB uses r3/r4 for small structure returns, "
3760 "%pB uses memory"), ibfd, last_struct);
3761 out_attr->type = ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_INT_VAL | ATTR_TYPE_FLAG_ERROR;
3762 ret = FALSE;
3763 }
3764 }
3765 if (!ret)
3766 {
3767 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3768 return FALSE;
3769 }
3770
3771 /* Merge Tag_compatibility attributes and any common GNU ones. */
3772 return _bfd_elf_merge_object_attributes (ibfd, info);
3773 }
3774
3775 /* Merge backend specific data from an object file to the output
3776 object file when linking. */
3777
3778 static bfd_boolean
3779 ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data (bfd *ibfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
3780 {
3781 bfd *obfd = info->output_bfd;
3782 flagword old_flags;
3783 flagword new_flags;
3784 bfd_boolean error;
3785
3786 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd) || !is_ppc_elf (obfd))
3787 return TRUE;
3788
3789 /* Check if we have the same endianness. */
3790 if (! _bfd_generic_verify_endian_match (ibfd, info))
3791 return FALSE;
3792
3793 if (!ppc_elf_merge_obj_attributes (ibfd, info))
3794 return FALSE;
3795
3796 new_flags = elf_elfheader (ibfd)->e_flags;
3797 old_flags = elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags;
3798 if (!elf_flags_init (obfd))
3799 {
3800 /* First call, no flags set. */
3801 elf_flags_init (obfd) = TRUE;
3802 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags = new_flags;
3803 }
3804
3805 /* Compatible flags are ok. */
3806 else if (new_flags == old_flags)
3807 ;
3808
3809 /* Incompatible flags. */
3810 else
3811 {
3812 /* Warn about -mrelocatable mismatch. Allow -mrelocatable-lib
3813 to be linked with either. */
3814 error = FALSE;
3815 if ((new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0
3816 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0)
3817 {
3818 error = TRUE;
3819 _bfd_error_handler
3820 (_("%pB: compiled with -mrelocatable and linked with "
3821 "modules compiled normally"), ibfd);
3822 }
3823 else if ((new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)) == 0
3824 && (old_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE) != 0)
3825 {
3826 error = TRUE;
3827 _bfd_error_handler
3828 (_("%pB: compiled normally and linked with "
3829 "modules compiled with -mrelocatable"), ibfd);
3830 }
3831
3832 /* The output is -mrelocatable-lib iff both the input files are. */
3833 if (! (new_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB))
3834 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags &= ~EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB;
3835
3836 /* The output is -mrelocatable iff it can't be -mrelocatable-lib,
3837 but each input file is either -mrelocatable or -mrelocatable-lib. */
3838 if (! (elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags & EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB)
3839 && (new_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE))
3840 && (old_flags & (EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE)))
3841 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE;
3842
3843 /* Do not warn about eabi vs. V.4 mismatch, just or in the bit if
3844 any module uses it. */
3845 elf_elfheader (obfd)->e_flags |= (new_flags & EF_PPC_EMB);
3846
3847 new_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3848 old_flags &= ~(EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE | EF_PPC_RELOCATABLE_LIB | EF_PPC_EMB);
3849
3850 /* Warn about any other mismatches. */
3851 if (new_flags != old_flags)
3852 {
3853 error = TRUE;
3854 _bfd_error_handler
3855 /* xgettext:c-format */
3856 (_("%pB: uses different e_flags (%#x) fields "
3857 "than previous modules (%#x)"),
3858 ibfd, new_flags, old_flags);
3859 }
3860
3861 if (error)
3862 {
3863 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
3864 return FALSE;
3865 }
3866 }
3867
3868 return TRUE;
3869 }
3870
3871 static void
3872 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (bfd *input_bfd,
3873 asection *input_section,
3874 unsigned long offset,
3875 bfd_byte *loc,
3876 bfd_vma value,
3877 split16_format_type split16_format,
3878 bfd_boolean fixup)
3879 {
3880 unsigned int insn, opcode;
3881
3882 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, loc);
3883 opcode = insn & E_OPCODE_MASK;
3884 if (opcode == E_OR2I_INSN
3885 || opcode == E_AND2I_DOT_INSN
3886 || opcode == E_OR2IS_INSN
3887 || opcode == E_LIS_INSN
3888 || opcode == E_AND2IS_DOT_INSN)
3889 {
3890 if (split16_format != split16a_type)
3891 {
3892 if (fixup)
3893 split16_format = split16a_type;
3894 else
3895 _bfd_error_handler
3896 /* xgettext:c-format */
3897 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16A style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3898 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3899 }
3900 }
3901 else if (opcode == E_ADD2I_DOT_INSN
3902 || opcode == E_ADD2IS_INSN
3903 || opcode == E_CMP16I_INSN
3904 || opcode == E_MULL2I_INSN
3905 || opcode == E_CMPL16I_INSN
3906 || opcode == E_CMPH16I_INSN
3907 || opcode == E_CMPHL16I_INSN)
3908 {
3909 if (split16_format != split16d_type)
3910 {
3911 if (fixup)
3912 split16_format = split16d_type;
3913 else
3914 _bfd_error_handler
3915 /* xgettext:c-format */
3916 (_("%pB(%pA+0x%lx): expected 16D style relocation on 0x%08x insn"),
3917 input_bfd, input_section, offset, opcode);
3918 }
3919 }
3920 if (split16_format == split16a_type)
3921 {
3922 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 5) | 0x7ff);
3923 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3924 if ((insn & E_LI_MASK) == E_LI_INSN)
3925 {
3926 /* Hack for e_li. Extend sign. */
3927 insn &= ~(0xf0000 >> 5);
3928 insn |= (-(value & 0x8000) & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3929 }
3930 }
3931 else
3932 {
3933 insn &= ~((0xf800 << 10) | 0x7ff);
3934 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 10;
3935 }
3936 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3937 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, loc);
3938 }
3939
3940 static void
3941 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (bfd *output_bfd, bfd_byte *loc, bfd_vma value)
3942 {
3943 unsigned int insn;
3944
3945 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
3946 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
3947 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
3948 insn |= (value & 0xf0000) >> 5;
3949 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
3950 insn |= (value & 0xf800) << 5;
3951 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
3952 insn |= value & 0x7ff;
3953 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, insn, loc);
3954 }
3955
3956 \f
3957 /* Choose which PLT scheme to use, and set .plt flags appropriately.
3958 Returns -1 on error, 0 for old PLT, 1 for new PLT. */
3959 int
3960 ppc_elf_select_plt_layout (bfd *output_bfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
3961 struct bfd_link_info *info)
3962 {
3963 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
3964 flagword flags;
3965
3966 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
3967
3968 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
3969 {
3970 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
3971
3972 if (htab->params->plt_style == PLT_OLD)
3973 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3974 else if (bfd_link_pic (info)
3975 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
3976 && (h = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "_mcount",
3977 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE)) != NULL
3978 && (h->type == STT_FUNC
3979 || h->needs_plt)
3980 && h->ref_regular
3981 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
3982 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
3983 {
3984 /* Profiling of shared libs (and pies) is not supported with
3985 secure plt, because ppc32 does profiling before a
3986 function prologue and a secure plt pic call stubs needs
3987 r30 to be set up. */
3988 htab->plt_type = PLT_OLD;
3989 }
3990 else
3991 {
3992 bfd *ibfd;
3993 enum ppc_elf_plt_type plt_type = htab->params->plt_style;
3994
3995 /* Look through the reloc flags left by ppc_elf_check_relocs.
3996 Use the old style bss plt if a file makes plt calls
3997 without using the new relocs, and if ld isn't given
3998 --secure-plt and we never see REL16 relocs. */
3999 if (plt_type == PLT_UNSET)
4000 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4001 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4002 if (is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4003 {
4004 if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->has_rel16)
4005 plt_type = PLT_NEW;
4006 else if (ppc_elf_tdata (ibfd)->makes_plt_call)
4007 {
4008 plt_type = PLT_OLD;
4009 htab->old_bfd = ibfd;
4010 break;
4011 }
4012 }
4013 htab->plt_type = plt_type;
4014 }
4015 }
4016 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD && htab->params->plt_style == PLT_NEW)
4017 {
4018 if (htab->old_bfd != NULL)
4019 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced due to %pB"), htab->old_bfd);
4020 else
4021 _bfd_error_handler (_("bss-plt forced by profiling"));
4022 }
4023
4024 BFD_ASSERT (htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS);
4025
4026 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
4027 {
4028 flags = (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_LOAD | SEC_HAS_CONTENTS
4029 | SEC_IN_MEMORY | SEC_LINKER_CREATED);
4030
4031 /* The new PLT is a loaded section. */
4032 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL
4033 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.splt, flags))
4034 return -1;
4035
4036 /* The new GOT is not executable. */
4037 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
4038 && !bfd_set_section_flags (htab->elf.sgot, flags))
4039 return -1;
4040 }
4041 else
4042 {
4043 /* Stop an unused .glink section from affecting .text alignment. */
4044 if (htab->glink != NULL
4045 && !bfd_set_section_alignment (htab->glink, 0))
4046 return -1;
4047 }
4048 return htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW;
4049 }
4050 \f
4051 /* Return the section that should be marked against GC for a given
4052 relocation. */
4053
4054 static asection *
4055 ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook (asection *sec,
4056 struct bfd_link_info *info,
4057 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4058 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4059 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
4060 {
4061 if (h != NULL)
4062 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
4063 {
4064 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
4065 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
4066 return NULL;
4067 }
4068
4069 return _bfd_elf_gc_mark_hook (sec, info, rel, h, sym);
4070 }
4071
4072 static bfd_boolean
4073 get_sym_h (struct elf_link_hash_entry **hp,
4074 Elf_Internal_Sym **symp,
4075 asection **symsecp,
4076 unsigned char **tls_maskp,
4077 Elf_Internal_Sym **locsymsp,
4078 unsigned long r_symndx,
4079 bfd *ibfd)
4080 {
4081 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4082
4083 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4084 {
4085 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4086 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4087
4088 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4089 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4090 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4091 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4092
4093 if (hp != NULL)
4094 *hp = h;
4095
4096 if (symp != NULL)
4097 *symp = NULL;
4098
4099 if (symsecp != NULL)
4100 {
4101 asection *symsec = NULL;
4102 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4103 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
4104 symsec = h->root.u.def.section;
4105 *symsecp = symsec;
4106 }
4107
4108 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4109 *tls_maskp = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4110 }
4111 else
4112 {
4113 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4114 Elf_Internal_Sym *locsyms = *locsymsp;
4115
4116 if (locsyms == NULL)
4117 {
4118 locsyms = (Elf_Internal_Sym *) symtab_hdr->contents;
4119 if (locsyms == NULL)
4120 locsyms = bfd_elf_get_elf_syms (ibfd, symtab_hdr,
4121 symtab_hdr->sh_info,
4122 0, NULL, NULL, NULL);
4123 if (locsyms == NULL)
4124 return FALSE;
4125 *locsymsp = locsyms;
4126 }
4127 sym = locsyms + r_symndx;
4128
4129 if (hp != NULL)
4130 *hp = NULL;
4131
4132 if (symp != NULL)
4133 *symp = sym;
4134
4135 if (symsecp != NULL)
4136 *symsecp = bfd_section_from_elf_index (ibfd, sym->st_shndx);
4137
4138 if (tls_maskp != NULL)
4139 {
4140 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
4141 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4142
4143 tls_mask = NULL;
4144 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4145 if (local_got != NULL)
4146 {
4147 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4148 (local_got + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4149 unsigned char *lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4150 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4151 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4152 }
4153 *tls_maskp = tls_mask;
4154 }
4155 }
4156 return TRUE;
4157 }
4158 \f
4159 /* Analyze inline PLT call relocations to see whether calls to locally
4160 defined functions can be converted to direct calls. */
4161
4162 bfd_boolean
4163 ppc_elf_inline_plt (struct bfd_link_info *info)
4164 {
4165 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4166 bfd *ibfd;
4167 asection *sec;
4168 bfd_vma low_vma, high_vma, limit;
4169
4170 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4171 if (htab == NULL)
4172 return FALSE;
4173
4174 /* A bl insn can reach -0x2000000 to 0x1fffffc. The limit is
4175 reduced somewhat to cater for possible stubs that might be added
4176 between the call and its destination. */
4177 limit = 0x1e00000;
4178 low_vma = -1;
4179 high_vma = 0;
4180 for (sec = info->output_bfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4181 if ((sec->flags & (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE)) == (SEC_ALLOC | SEC_CODE))
4182 {
4183 if (low_vma > sec->vma)
4184 low_vma = sec->vma;
4185 if (high_vma < sec->vma + sec->size)
4186 high_vma = sec->vma + sec->size;
4187 }
4188
4189 /* If a "bl" can reach anywhere in local code sections, then we can
4190 convert all inline PLT sequences to direct calls when the symbol
4191 is local. */
4192 if (high_vma - low_vma < limit)
4193 {
4194 htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt = 1;
4195 return TRUE;
4196 }
4197
4198 /* Otherwise, go looking through relocs for cases where a direct
4199 call won't reach. Mark the symbol on any such reloc to disable
4200 the optimization and keep the PLT entry as it seems likely that
4201 this will be better than creating trampolines. Note that this
4202 will disable the optimization for all inline PLT calls to a
4203 particular symbol, not just those that won't reach. The
4204 difficulty in doing a more precise optimization is that the
4205 linker needs to make a decision depending on whether a
4206 particular R_PPC_PLTCALL insn can be turned into a direct
4207 call, for each of the R_PPC_PLTSEQ and R_PPC_PLT16* insns in
4208 the sequence, and there is nothing that ties those relocs
4209 together except their symbol. */
4210
4211 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4212 {
4213 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
4214 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms;
4215
4216 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
4217 continue;
4218
4219 local_syms = NULL;
4220 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4221
4222 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4223 if (sec->has_pltcall
4224 && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4225 {
4226 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4227
4228 /* Read the relocations. */
4229 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4230 info->keep_memory);
4231 if (relstart == NULL)
4232 return FALSE;
4233
4234 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4235 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; )
4236 {
4237 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4238 unsigned long r_symndx;
4239 asection *sym_sec;
4240 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4241 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
4242 unsigned char *tls_maskp;
4243
4244 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4245 if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTCALL)
4246 continue;
4247
4248 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4249 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &sym, &sym_sec, &tls_maskp, &local_syms,
4250 r_symndx, ibfd))
4251 {
4252 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4253 free (relstart);
4254 if (local_syms != NULL
4255 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4256 free (local_syms);
4257 return FALSE;
4258 }
4259
4260 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
4261 {
4262 bfd_vma from, to;
4263 if (h != NULL)
4264 to = h->root.u.def.value;
4265 else
4266 to = sym->st_value;
4267 to += (rel->r_addend
4268 + sym_sec->output_offset
4269 + sym_sec->output_section->vma);
4270 from = (rel->r_offset
4271 + sec->output_offset
4272 + sec->output_section->vma);
4273 if (to - from + limit < 2 * limit)
4274 *tls_maskp &= ~PLT_KEEP;
4275 }
4276 }
4277 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4278 free (relstart);
4279 }
4280
4281 if (local_syms != NULL
4282 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
4283 {
4284 if (!info->keep_memory)
4285 free (local_syms);
4286 else
4287 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
4288 }
4289 }
4290
4291 return TRUE;
4292 }
4293
4294 /* Set plt output section type, htab->tls_get_addr, and call the
4295 generic ELF tls_setup function. */
4296
4297 asection *
4298 ppc_elf_tls_setup (bfd *obfd, struct bfd_link_info *info)
4299 {
4300 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4301
4302 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4303 htab->tls_get_addr = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr",
4304 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4305 if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
4306 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4307
4308 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
4309 {
4310 struct elf_link_hash_entry *opt, *tga;
4311 opt = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__tls_get_addr_opt",
4312 FALSE, FALSE, TRUE);
4313 if (opt != NULL
4314 && (opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
4315 || opt->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
4316 {
4317 /* If glibc supports an optimized __tls_get_addr call stub,
4318 signalled by the presence of __tls_get_addr_opt, and we'll
4319 be calling __tls_get_addr via a plt call stub, then
4320 make __tls_get_addr point to __tls_get_addr_opt. */
4321 tga = htab->tls_get_addr;
4322 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
4323 && tga != NULL
4324 && (tga->type == STT_FUNC
4325 || tga->needs_plt)
4326 && !(SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, tga)
4327 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, tga)))
4328 {
4329 struct plt_entry *ent;
4330 for (ent = tga->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4331 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4332 break;
4333 if (ent != NULL)
4334 {
4335 tga->root.type = bfd_link_hash_indirect;
4336 tga->root.u.i.link = &opt->root;
4337 ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol (info, opt, tga);
4338 opt->mark = 1;
4339 if (opt->dynindx != -1)
4340 {
4341 /* Use __tls_get_addr_opt in dynamic relocations. */
4342 opt->dynindx = -1;
4343 _bfd_elf_strtab_delref (elf_hash_table (info)->dynstr,
4344 opt->dynstr_index);
4345 if (!bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, opt))
4346 return FALSE;
4347 }
4348 htab->tls_get_addr = opt;
4349 }
4350 }
4351 }
4352 else
4353 htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt = TRUE;
4354 }
4355 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
4356 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
4357 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != NULL)
4358 {
4359 elf_section_type (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHT_PROGBITS;
4360 elf_section_flags (htab->elf.splt->output_section) = SHF_ALLOC + SHF_WRITE;
4361 }
4362
4363 return _bfd_elf_tls_setup (obfd, info);
4364 }
4365
4366 /* Return TRUE iff REL is a branch reloc with a global symbol matching
4367 HASH. */
4368
4369 static bfd_boolean
4370 branch_reloc_hash_match (const bfd *ibfd,
4371 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel,
4372 const struct elf_link_hash_entry *hash)
4373 {
4374 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4375 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4376 unsigned int r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4377
4378 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4379 {
4380 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4381 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
4382
4383 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4384 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4385 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4386 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4387 if (h == hash)
4388 return TRUE;
4389 }
4390 return FALSE;
4391 }
4392
4393 /* Run through all the TLS relocs looking for optimization
4394 opportunities. */
4395
4396 bfd_boolean
4397 ppc_elf_tls_optimize (bfd *obfd ATTRIBUTE_UNUSED,
4398 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4399 {
4400 bfd *ibfd;
4401 asection *sec;
4402 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4403 int pass;
4404
4405 if (!bfd_link_executable (info))
4406 return TRUE;
4407
4408 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4409 if (htab == NULL)
4410 return FALSE;
4411
4412 /* Make two passes through the relocs. First time check that tls
4413 relocs involved in setting up a tls_get_addr call are indeed
4414 followed by such a call. If they are not, don't do any tls
4415 optimization. On the second pass twiddle tls_mask flags to
4416 notify relocate_section that optimization can be done, and
4417 adjust got and plt refcounts. */
4418 for (pass = 0; pass < 2; ++pass)
4419 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
4420 {
4421 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
4422 asection *got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (ibfd, ".got2");
4423
4424 for (sec = ibfd->sections; sec != NULL; sec = sec->next)
4425 if (sec->has_tls_reloc && !bfd_is_abs_section (sec->output_section))
4426 {
4427 Elf_Internal_Rela *relstart, *rel, *relend;
4428 int expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4429
4430 /* Read the relocations. */
4431 relstart = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (ibfd, sec, NULL, NULL,
4432 info->keep_memory);
4433 if (relstart == NULL)
4434 return FALSE;
4435
4436 relend = relstart + sec->reloc_count;
4437 for (rel = relstart; rel < relend; rel++)
4438 {
4439 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
4440 unsigned long r_symndx;
4441 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h = NULL;
4442 unsigned char *tls_mask;
4443 unsigned char tls_set, tls_clear;
4444 bfd_boolean is_local;
4445 bfd_signed_vma *got_count;
4446
4447 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
4448 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4449 {
4450 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4451
4452 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4453 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4454 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4455 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4456 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4457 }
4458
4459 is_local = SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h);
4460 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
4461 /* If this section has old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4462 without marker relocs, then check that each
4463 __tls_get_addr call reloc is preceded by a reloc
4464 that conceivably belongs to the __tls_get_addr arg
4465 setup insn. If we don't find matching arg setup
4466 relocs, don't do any tls optimization. */
4467 if (pass == 0
4468 && sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4469 && h != NULL
4470 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
4471 && !expecting_tls_get_addr
4472 && is_branch_reloc (r_type))
4473 {
4474 info->callbacks->minfo ("%H __tls_get_addr lost arg, "
4475 "TLS optimization disabled\n",
4476 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4477 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4478 free (relstart);
4479 return TRUE;
4480 }
4481
4482 expecting_tls_get_addr = 0;
4483 switch (r_type)
4484 {
4485 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
4486 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
4487 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4488 /* Fall through. */
4489
4490 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
4491 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
4492 /* These relocs should never be against a symbol
4493 defined in a shared lib. Leave them alone if
4494 that turns out to be the case. */
4495 if (!is_local)
4496 continue;
4497
4498 /* LD -> LE */
4499 tls_set = 0;
4500 tls_clear = TLS_LD;
4501 break;
4502
4503 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
4504 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
4505 expecting_tls_get_addr = 1;
4506 /* Fall through. */
4507
4508 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
4509 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
4510 if (is_local)
4511 /* GD -> LE */
4512 tls_set = 0;
4513 else
4514 /* GD -> IE */
4515 tls_set = TLS_TLS | TLS_GDIE;
4516 tls_clear = TLS_GD;
4517 break;
4518
4519 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
4520 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
4521 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
4522 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
4523 if (is_local)
4524 {
4525 /* IE -> LE */
4526 tls_set = 0;
4527 tls_clear = TLS_TPREL;
4528 break;
4529 }
4530 else
4531 continue;
4532
4533 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
4534 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
4535 if (rel + 1 < relend
4536 && is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
4537 {
4538 if (pass != 0
4539 && ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) != R_PPC_PLTSEQ)
4540 {
4541 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info);
4542 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel[1].r_info);
4543 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
4544 {
4545 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
4546
4547 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (ibfd);
4548 h = sym_hashes[r_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
4549 while (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
4550 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
4551 h = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) h->root.u.i.link;
4552 if (h != NULL)
4553 {
4554 struct plt_entry *ent = NULL;
4555 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4556
4557 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4558 addend = rel->r_addend;
4559 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist,
4560 got2, addend);
4561 if (ent != NULL
4562 && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4563 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4564 }
4565 }
4566 }
4567 continue;
4568 }
4569 expecting_tls_get_addr = 2;
4570 tls_set = 0;
4571 tls_clear = 0;
4572 break;
4573
4574 default:
4575 continue;
4576 }
4577
4578 if (pass == 0)
4579 {
4580 if (!expecting_tls_get_addr
4581 || !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr)
4582 continue;
4583
4584 if (rel + 1 < relend
4585 && branch_reloc_hash_match (ibfd, rel + 1,
4586 htab->tls_get_addr))
4587 continue;
4588
4589 /* Uh oh, we didn't find the expected call. We
4590 could just mark this symbol to exclude it
4591 from tls optimization but it's safer to skip
4592 the entire optimization. */
4593 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%H arg lost __tls_get_addr, "
4594 "TLS optimization disabled\n"),
4595 ibfd, sec, rel->r_offset);
4596 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4597 free (relstart);
4598 return TRUE;
4599 }
4600
4601 if (h != NULL)
4602 {
4603 tls_mask = &ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask;
4604 got_count = &h->got.refcount;
4605 }
4606 else
4607 {
4608 bfd_signed_vma *lgot_refs;
4609 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
4610 unsigned char *lgot_masks;
4611
4612 lgot_refs = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
4613 if (lgot_refs == NULL)
4614 abort ();
4615 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
4616 (lgot_refs + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4617 lgot_masks = (unsigned char *)
4618 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
4619 tls_mask = &lgot_masks[r_symndx];
4620 got_count = &lgot_refs[r_symndx];
4621 }
4622
4623 /* If we don't have old-style __tls_get_addr calls
4624 without TLSGD/TLSLD marker relocs, and we haven't
4625 found a new-style __tls_get_addr call with a
4626 marker for this symbol, then we either have a
4627 broken object file or an -mlongcall style
4628 indirect call to __tls_get_addr without a marker.
4629 Disable optimization in this case. */
4630 if ((tls_clear & (TLS_GD | TLS_LD)) != 0
4631 && !sec->nomark_tls_get_addr
4632 && ((*tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK))
4633 != (TLS_TLS | TLS_MARK)))
4634 continue;
4635
4636 if (expecting_tls_get_addr)
4637 {
4638 struct plt_entry *ent;
4639 bfd_vma addend = 0;
4640
4641 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
4642 && (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTREL24
4643 || ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info) == R_PPC_PLTCALL))
4644 addend = rel[1].r_addend;
4645 ent = find_plt_ent (&htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist,
4646 got2, addend);
4647 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4648 ent->plt.refcount -= 1;
4649
4650 if (expecting_tls_get_addr == 2)
4651 continue;
4652 }
4653
4654 if (tls_set == 0)
4655 {
4656 /* We managed to get rid of a got entry. */
4657 if (*got_count > 0)
4658 *got_count -= 1;
4659 }
4660
4661 *tls_mask |= tls_set;
4662 *tls_mask &= ~tls_clear;
4663 }
4664
4665 if (elf_section_data (sec)->relocs != relstart)
4666 free (relstart);
4667 }
4668 }
4669 htab->do_tls_opt = 1;
4670 return TRUE;
4671 }
4672 \f
4673 /* Find dynamic relocs for H that apply to read-only sections. */
4674
4675 static asection *
4676 readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4677 {
4678 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4679
4680 for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4681 {
4682 asection *s = p->sec->output_section;
4683
4684 if (s != NULL && (s->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4685 return p->sec;
4686 }
4687 return NULL;
4688 }
4689
4690 /* Return true if we have dynamic relocs against H or any of its weak
4691 aliases, that apply to read-only sections. Cannot be used after
4692 size_dynamic_sections. */
4693
4694 static bfd_boolean
4695 alias_readonly_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4696 {
4697 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h);
4698 do
4699 {
4700 if (readonly_dynrelocs (&eh->elf))
4701 return TRUE;
4702 eh = ppc_elf_hash_entry (eh->elf.u.alias);
4703 } while (eh != NULL && &eh->elf != h);
4704
4705 return FALSE;
4706 }
4707
4708 /* Return whether H has pc-relative dynamic relocs. */
4709
4710 static bfd_boolean
4711 pc_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4712 {
4713 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
4714
4715 for (p = ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
4716 if (p->pc_count != 0)
4717 return TRUE;
4718 return FALSE;
4719 }
4720
4721 /* Adjust a symbol defined by a dynamic object and referenced by a
4722 regular object. The current definition is in some section of the
4723 dynamic object, but we're not including those sections. We have to
4724 change the definition to something the rest of the link can
4725 understand. */
4726
4727 static bfd_boolean
4728 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol (struct bfd_link_info *info,
4729 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
4730 {
4731 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
4732 asection *s;
4733
4734 #ifdef DEBUG
4735 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol called for %s\n",
4736 h->root.root.string);
4737 #endif
4738
4739 /* Make sure we know what is going on here. */
4740 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4741 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL
4742 && (h->needs_plt
4743 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4744 || h->is_weakalias
4745 || (h->def_dynamic
4746 && h->ref_regular
4747 && !h->def_regular)));
4748
4749 /* Deal with function syms. */
4750 if (h->type == STT_FUNC
4751 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
4752 || h->needs_plt)
4753 {
4754 bfd_boolean local = (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
4755 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h));
4756 /* Discard dyn_relocs when non-pic if we've decided that a
4757 function symbol is local. */
4758 if (!bfd_link_pic (info) && local)
4759 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4760
4761 /* Clear procedure linkage table information for any symbol that
4762 won't need a .plt entry. */
4763 struct plt_entry *ent;
4764 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
4765 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
4766 break;
4767 if (ent == NULL
4768 || (h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC
4769 && local
4770 && (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
4771 || (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
4772 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)))
4773 {
4774 /* A PLT entry is not required/allowed when:
4775
4776 1. We are not using ld.so; because then the PLT entry
4777 can't be set up, so we can't use one. In this case,
4778 ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol won't even be called.
4779
4780 2. GC has rendered the entry unused.
4781
4782 3. We know for certain that a call to this symbol
4783 will go to this object, or will remain undefined. */
4784 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4785 h->needs_plt = 0;
4786 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4787 }
4788 else
4789 {
4790 /* Taking a function's address in a read/write section
4791 doesn't require us to define the function symbol in the
4792 executable on a plt call stub. A dynamic reloc can
4793 be used instead, giving better runtime performance.
4794 (Calls via that function pointer don't need to bounce
4795 through the plt call stub.) Similarly, use a dynamic
4796 reloc for a weak reference when possible, allowing the
4797 resolution of the symbol to be set at load time rather
4798 than link time. */
4799 if ((h->pointer_equality_needed
4800 || (h->non_got_ref
4801 && !h->ref_regular_nonweak
4802 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h)))
4803 && !htab->is_vxworks
4804 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4805 && !readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4806 {
4807 h->pointer_equality_needed = 0;
4808 /* If we haven't seen a branch reloc and the symbol
4809 isn't an ifunc then we don't need a plt entry. */
4810 if (!h->needs_plt && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
4811 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4812 }
4813 else if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
4814 /* We are going to be defining the function symbol on the
4815 plt stub, so no dyn_relocs needed when non-pic. */
4816 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4817 }
4818 h->protected_def = 0;
4819 /* Function symbols can't have copy relocs. */
4820 return TRUE;
4821 }
4822 else
4823 h->plt.plist = NULL;
4824
4825 /* If this is a weak symbol, and there is a real definition, the
4826 processor independent code will have arranged for us to see the
4827 real definition first, and we can just use the same value. */
4828 if (h->is_weakalias)
4829 {
4830 struct elf_link_hash_entry *def = weakdef (h);
4831 BFD_ASSERT (def->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined);
4832 h->root.u.def.section = def->root.u.def.section;
4833 h->root.u.def.value = def->root.u.def.value;
4834 if (def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynbss
4835 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro
4836 || def->root.u.def.section == htab->dynsbss)
4837 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4838 return TRUE;
4839 }
4840
4841 /* This is a reference to a symbol defined by a dynamic object which
4842 is not a function. */
4843
4844 /* If we are creating a shared library, we must presume that the
4845 only references to the symbol are via the global offset table.
4846 For such cases we need not do anything here; the relocations will
4847 be handled correctly by relocate_section. */
4848 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4849 {
4850 h->protected_def = 0;
4851 return TRUE;
4852 }
4853
4854 /* If there are no references to this symbol that do not use the
4855 GOT, we don't need to generate a copy reloc. */
4856 if (!h->non_got_ref)
4857 {
4858 h->protected_def = 0;
4859 return TRUE;
4860 }
4861
4862 /* Protected variables do not work with .dynbss. The copy in
4863 .dynbss won't be used by the shared library with the protected
4864 definition for the variable. Editing to PIC, or text relocations
4865 are preferable to an incorrect program. */
4866 if (h->protected_def)
4867 {
4868 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4869 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
4870 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
4871 && htab->params->pic_fixup == 0
4872 && info->disable_target_specific_optimizations <= 1)
4873 htab->params->pic_fixup = 1;
4874 return TRUE;
4875 }
4876
4877 /* If -z nocopyreloc was given, we won't generate them either. */
4878 if (info->nocopyreloc)
4879 return TRUE;
4880
4881 /* If we don't find any dynamic relocs in read-only sections, then
4882 we'll be keeping the dynamic relocs and avoiding the copy reloc.
4883 We can't do this if there are any small data relocations. This
4884 doesn't work on VxWorks, where we can not have dynamic
4885 relocations (other than copy and jump slot relocations) in an
4886 executable. */
4887 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
4888 && !ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs
4889 && !htab->is_vxworks
4890 && !h->def_regular
4891 && !alias_readonly_dynrelocs (h))
4892 return TRUE;
4893
4894 /* We must allocate the symbol in our .dynbss section, which will
4895 become part of the .bss section of the executable. There will be
4896 an entry for this symbol in the .dynsym section. The dynamic
4897 object will contain position independent code, so all references
4898 from the dynamic object to this symbol will go through the global
4899 offset table. The dynamic linker will use the .dynsym entry to
4900 determine the address it must put in the global offset table, so
4901 both the dynamic object and the regular object will refer to the
4902 same memory location for the variable.
4903
4904 Of course, if the symbol is referenced using SDAREL relocs, we
4905 must instead allocate it in .sbss. */
4906 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4907 s = htab->dynsbss;
4908 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4909 s = htab->elf.sdynrelro;
4910 else
4911 s = htab->elf.sdynbss;
4912 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
4913
4914 if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) != 0 && h->size != 0)
4915 {
4916 asection *srel;
4917
4918 /* We must generate a R_PPC_COPY reloc to tell the dynamic
4919 linker to copy the initial value out of the dynamic object
4920 and into the runtime process image. */
4921 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
4922 srel = htab->relsbss;
4923 else if ((h->root.u.def.section->flags & SEC_READONLY) != 0)
4924 srel = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
4925 else
4926 srel = htab->elf.srelbss;
4927 BFD_ASSERT (srel != NULL);
4928 srel->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
4929 h->needs_copy = 1;
4930 }
4931
4932 /* We no longer want dyn_relocs. */
4933 ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs = NULL;
4934 return _bfd_elf_adjust_dynamic_copy (info, h, s);
4935 }
4936 \f
4937 /* Generate a symbol to mark plt call stubs. For non-PIC code the sym is
4938 xxxxxxxx.plt_call32.<callee> where xxxxxxxx is a hex number, usually 0,
4939 specifying the addend on the plt relocation. For -fpic code, the sym
4940 is xxxxxxxx.plt_pic32.<callee>, and for -fPIC
4941 xxxxxxxx.got2.plt_pic32.<callee>. */
4942
4943 static bfd_boolean
4944 add_stub_sym (struct plt_entry *ent,
4945 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
4946 struct bfd_link_info *info)
4947 {
4948 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
4949 size_t len1, len2, len3;
4950 char *name;
4951 const char *stub;
4952 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
4953
4954 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
4955 stub = ".plt_pic32.";
4956 else
4957 stub = ".plt_call32.";
4958
4959 len1 = strlen (h->root.root.string);
4960 len2 = strlen (stub);
4961 len3 = 0;
4962 if (ent->sec)
4963 len3 = strlen (ent->sec->name);
4964 name = bfd_malloc (len1 + len2 + len3 + 9);
4965 if (name == NULL)
4966 return FALSE;
4967 sprintf (name, "%08x", (unsigned) ent->addend & 0xffffffff);
4968 if (ent->sec)
4969 memcpy (name + 8, ent->sec->name, len3);
4970 memcpy (name + 8 + len3, stub, len2);
4971 memcpy (name + 8 + len3 + len2, h->root.root.string, len1 + 1);
4972 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, name, TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
4973 if (sh == NULL)
4974 return FALSE;
4975 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
4976 {
4977 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
4978 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
4979 sh->root.u.def.value = ent->glink_offset;
4980 sh->ref_regular = 1;
4981 sh->def_regular = 1;
4982 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
4983 sh->forced_local = 1;
4984 sh->non_elf = 0;
4985 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
4986 }
4987 return TRUE;
4988 }
4989
4990 /* Allocate NEED contiguous space in .got, and return the offset.
4991 Handles allocation of the got header when crossing 32k. */
4992
4993 static bfd_vma
4994 allocate_got (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab, unsigned int need)
4995 {
4996 bfd_vma where;
4997 unsigned int max_before_header;
4998
4999 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5000 {
5001 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5002 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5003 }
5004 else
5005 {
5006 max_before_header = htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW ? 32768 : 32764;
5007 if (need <= htab->got_gap)
5008 {
5009 where = max_before_header - htab->got_gap;
5010 htab->got_gap -= need;
5011 }
5012 else
5013 {
5014 if (htab->elf.sgot->size + need > max_before_header
5015 && htab->elf.sgot->size <= max_before_header)
5016 {
5017 htab->got_gap = max_before_header - htab->elf.sgot->size;
5018 htab->elf.sgot->size = max_before_header + htab->got_header_size;
5019 }
5020 where = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5021 htab->elf.sgot->size += need;
5022 }
5023 }
5024 return where;
5025 }
5026
5027 /* Calculate size of GOT entries for symbol given its TLS_MASK.
5028 TLS_LD is excluded because those go in a special GOT slot. */
5029
5030 static inline unsigned int
5031 got_entries_needed (int tls_mask)
5032 {
5033 unsigned int need;
5034 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) == 0)
5035 need = 4;
5036 else
5037 {
5038 need = 0;
5039 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
5040 need += 8;
5041 if ((tls_mask & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
5042 need += 4;
5043 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
5044 need += 4;
5045 }
5046 return need;
5047 }
5048
5049 /* If H is undefined, make it dynamic if that makes sense. */
5050
5051 static bfd_boolean
5052 ensure_undef_dynamic (struct bfd_link_info *info,
5053 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
5054 {
5055 struct elf_link_hash_table *htab = elf_hash_table (info);
5056
5057 if (htab->dynamic_sections_created
5058 && ((info->dynamic_undefined_weak != 0
5059 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
5060 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
5061 && h->dynindx == -1
5062 && !h->forced_local
5063 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) == STV_DEFAULT)
5064 return bfd_elf_link_record_dynamic_symbol (info, h);
5065 return TRUE;
5066 }
5067
5068 /* Allocate space in associated reloc sections for dynamic relocs. */
5069
5070 static bfd_boolean
5071 allocate_dynrelocs (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
5072 {
5073 struct bfd_link_info *info = inf;
5074 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
5075 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5076 struct elf_dyn_relocs *p;
5077 bfd_boolean dyn;
5078
5079 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5080 return TRUE;
5081
5082 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5083 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
5084 if (eh->elf.got.refcount > 0
5085 || (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
5086 && !eh->elf.def_regular
5087 && eh->elf.protected_def
5088 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5089 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5090 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5091 {
5092 unsigned int need;
5093
5094 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5095 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, &eh->elf))
5096 return FALSE;
5097
5098 need = 0;
5099 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5100 {
5101 if (SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf))
5102 /* We'll just use htab->tlsld_got.offset. This should
5103 always be the case. It's a little odd if we have
5104 a local dynamic reloc against a non-local symbol. */
5105 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5106 else
5107 need += 8;
5108 }
5109 need += got_entries_needed (eh->tls_mask);
5110 if (need == 0)
5111 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5112 else
5113 {
5114 eh->elf.got.offset = allocate_got (htab, need);
5115 if (((bfd_link_pic (info)
5116 && !((eh->tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
5117 && bfd_link_executable (info)
5118 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5119 || (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5120 && eh->elf.dynindx != -1
5121 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, &eh->elf)))
5122 && !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, &eh->elf))
5123 {
5124 asection *rsec;
5125
5126 need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5127 if ((eh->tls_mask & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5128 need -= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5129 rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
5130 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5131 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
5132 rsec->size += need;
5133 }
5134 }
5135 }
5136 else
5137 eh->elf.got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5138
5139 /* If no dynamic sections we can't have dynamic relocs, except for
5140 IFUNCs which are handled even in static executables. */
5141 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5142 && h->type != STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5143 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5144
5145 /* Discard relocs on undefined symbols that must be local. */
5146 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
5147 && ELF_ST_VISIBILITY (h->other) != STV_DEFAULT)
5148 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5149
5150 /* Also discard relocs on undefined weak syms with non-default
5151 visibility, or when dynamic_undefined_weak says so. */
5152 else if (UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
5153 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5154
5155 if (eh->dyn_relocs == NULL)
5156 ;
5157
5158 /* In the shared -Bsymbolic case, discard space allocated for
5159 dynamic pc-relative relocs against symbols which turn out to be
5160 defined in regular objects. For the normal shared case, discard
5161 space for relocs that have become local due to symbol visibility
5162 changes. */
5163 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5164 {
5165 /* Relocs that use pc_count are those that appear on a call insn,
5166 or certain REL relocs (see must_be_dyn_reloc) that can be
5167 generated via assembly. We want calls to protected symbols to
5168 resolve directly to the function rather than going via the plt.
5169 If people want function pointer comparisons to work as expected
5170 then they should avoid writing weird assembly. */
5171 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h))
5172 {
5173 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5174
5175 for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5176 {
5177 p->count -= p->pc_count;
5178 p->pc_count = 0;
5179 if (p->count == 0)
5180 *pp = p->next;
5181 else
5182 pp = &p->next;
5183 }
5184 }
5185
5186 if (htab->is_vxworks)
5187 {
5188 struct elf_dyn_relocs **pp;
5189
5190 for (pp = &eh->dyn_relocs; (p = *pp) != NULL; )
5191 {
5192 if (strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name, ".tls_vars") == 0)
5193 *pp = p->next;
5194 else
5195 pp = &p->next;
5196 }
5197 }
5198
5199 if (eh->dyn_relocs != NULL)
5200 {
5201 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5202 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5203 return FALSE;
5204 }
5205 }
5206 else if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS)
5207 {
5208 /* For the non-pic case, discard space for relocs against
5209 symbols which turn out to need copy relocs or are not
5210 dynamic. */
5211 if (h->dynamic_adjusted
5212 && !h->def_regular
5213 && !ELF_COMMON_DEF_P (h)
5214 && !(h->protected_def
5215 && eh->has_addr16_ha
5216 && eh->has_addr16_lo
5217 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0))
5218 {
5219 /* Make sure this symbol is output as a dynamic symbol. */
5220 if (!ensure_undef_dynamic (info, h))
5221 return FALSE;
5222
5223 if (h->dynindx == -1)
5224 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5225 }
5226 else
5227 eh->dyn_relocs = NULL;
5228 }
5229
5230 /* Allocate space. */
5231 for (p = eh->dyn_relocs; p != NULL; p = p->next)
5232 {
5233 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5234 if (eh->elf.type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5235 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5236 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5237 }
5238
5239 /* Handle PLT relocs. Done last, after dynindx has settled.
5240 We might need a PLT entry when the symbol
5241 a) is dynamic, or
5242 b) is an ifunc, or
5243 c) has plt16 relocs and has been processed by adjust_dynamic_symbol, or
5244 d) has plt16 relocs and we are linking statically. */
5245 dyn = htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created && h->dynindx != -1;
5246 if (dyn
5247 || h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
5248 || (h->needs_plt && h->dynamic_adjusted)
5249 || (h->needs_plt
5250 && h->def_regular
5251 && !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
5252 && !htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5253 && (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->tls_mask
5254 & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) == PLT_KEEP))
5255 {
5256 struct plt_entry *ent;
5257 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5258 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5259
5260 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5261 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5262 {
5263 asection *s = htab->elf.splt;
5264
5265 if (!dyn)
5266 {
5267 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5268 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5269 else
5270 s = htab->pltlocal;
5271 }
5272
5273 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW || !dyn)
5274 {
5275 if (!doneone)
5276 {
5277 plt_offset = s->size;
5278 s->size += 4;
5279 }
5280 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5281
5282 if (s == htab->pltlocal)
5283 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5284 else
5285 {
5286 s = htab->glink;
5287 if (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info))
5288 {
5289 glink_offset = s->size;
5290 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
5291 }
5292 if (!doneone
5293 && !bfd_link_pic (info)
5294 && h->def_dynamic
5295 && !h->def_regular)
5296 {
5297 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5298 h->root.u.def.value = glink_offset;
5299 }
5300 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5301
5302 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms
5303 && !add_stub_sym (ent, h, info))
5304 return FALSE;
5305 }
5306 }
5307 else
5308 {
5309 if (!doneone)
5310 {
5311 /* If this is the first .plt entry, make room
5312 for the special first entry. */
5313 if (s->size == 0)
5314 s->size += htab->plt_initial_entry_size;
5315
5316 /* The PowerPC PLT is actually composed of two
5317 parts, the first part is 2 words (for a load
5318 and a jump), and then there is a remaining
5319 word available at the end. */
5320 plt_offset = (htab->plt_initial_entry_size
5321 + (htab->plt_slot_size
5322 * ((s->size
5323 - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5324 / htab->plt_entry_size)));
5325
5326 /* If this symbol is not defined in a regular
5327 file, and we are not generating a shared
5328 library, then set the symbol to this location
5329 in the .plt. This is to avoid text
5330 relocations, and is required to make
5331 function pointers compare as equal between
5332 the normal executable and the shared library. */
5333 if (! bfd_link_pic (info)
5334 && h->def_dynamic
5335 && !h->def_regular)
5336 {
5337 h->root.u.def.section = s;
5338 h->root.u.def.value = plt_offset;
5339 }
5340
5341 /* Make room for this entry. */
5342 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5343 /* After the 8192nd entry, room for two entries
5344 is allocated. */
5345 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
5346 && (s->size - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5347 / htab->plt_entry_size
5348 > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES)
5349 s->size += htab->plt_entry_size;
5350 }
5351 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5352 }
5353
5354 /* We also need to make an entry in the .rela.plt section. */
5355 if (!doneone)
5356 {
5357 if (!dyn)
5358 {
5359 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
5360 {
5361 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5362 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5363 }
5364 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5365 {
5366 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5367 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5368 }
5369 }
5370 else
5371 {
5372 htab->elf.srelplt->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5373
5374 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS)
5375 {
5376 /* Allocate space for the unloaded relocations. */
5377 if (!bfd_link_pic (info)
5378 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5379 {
5380 if (ent->plt.offset
5381 == (bfd_vma) htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
5382 {
5383 htab->srelplt2->size
5384 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5385 * VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS);
5386 }
5387
5388 htab->srelplt2->size
5389 += (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)
5390 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS);
5391 }
5392
5393 /* Every PLT entry has an associated GOT entry in
5394 .got.plt. */
5395 htab->elf.sgotplt->size += 4;
5396 }
5397 }
5398 doneone = TRUE;
5399 }
5400 }
5401 else
5402 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5403
5404 if (!doneone)
5405 {
5406 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5407 h->needs_plt = 0;
5408 }
5409 }
5410 else
5411 {
5412 h->plt.plist = NULL;
5413 h->needs_plt = 0;
5414 }
5415
5416 return TRUE;
5417 }
5418
5419 /* Set DF_TEXTREL if we find any dynamic relocs that apply to
5420 read-only sections. */
5421
5422 static bfd_boolean
5423 maybe_set_textrel (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *info_p)
5424 {
5425 asection *sec;
5426
5427 if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect)
5428 return TRUE;
5429
5430 sec = readonly_dynrelocs (h);
5431 if (sec != NULL)
5432 {
5433 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) info_p;
5434
5435 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5436 info->callbacks->minfo
5437 (_("%pB: dynamic relocation against `%pT' in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5438 sec->owner, h->root.root.string, sec);
5439
5440 /* Not an error, just cut short the traversal. */
5441 return FALSE;
5442 }
5443 return TRUE;
5444 }
5445
5446 static const unsigned char glink_eh_frame_cie[] =
5447 {
5448 0, 0, 0, 16, /* length. */
5449 0, 0, 0, 0, /* id. */
5450 1, /* CIE version. */
5451 'z', 'R', 0, /* Augmentation string. */
5452 4, /* Code alignment. */
5453 0x7c, /* Data alignment. */
5454 65, /* RA reg. */
5455 1, /* Augmentation size. */
5456 DW_EH_PE_pcrel | DW_EH_PE_sdata4, /* FDE encoding. */
5457 DW_CFA_def_cfa, 1, 0 /* def_cfa: r1 offset 0. */
5458 };
5459
5460 /* Set the sizes of the dynamic sections. */
5461
5462 static bfd_boolean
5463 ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
5464 struct bfd_link_info *info)
5465 {
5466 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
5467 asection *s;
5468 bfd_boolean relocs;
5469 bfd *ibfd;
5470
5471 #ifdef DEBUG
5472 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections called\n");
5473 #endif
5474
5475 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
5476 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.dynobj != NULL);
5477
5478 if (elf_hash_table (info)->dynamic_sections_created)
5479 {
5480 /* Set the contents of the .interp section to the interpreter. */
5481 if (bfd_link_executable (info) && !info->nointerp)
5482 {
5483 s = bfd_get_linker_section (htab->elf.dynobj, ".interp");
5484 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
5485 s->size = sizeof ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5486 s->contents = (unsigned char *) ELF_DYNAMIC_INTERPRETER;
5487 }
5488 }
5489
5490 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5491 htab->got_header_size = 16;
5492 else if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
5493 htab->got_header_size = 12;
5494
5495 /* Set up .got offsets for local syms, and space for local dynamic
5496 relocs. */
5497 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
5498 {
5499 bfd_signed_vma *local_got;
5500 bfd_signed_vma *end_local_got;
5501 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
5502 struct plt_entry **end_local_plt;
5503 char *lgot_masks;
5504 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
5505 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
5506
5507 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
5508 continue;
5509
5510 for (s = ibfd->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5511 {
5512 struct ppc_dyn_relocs *p;
5513
5514 for (p = ((struct ppc_dyn_relocs *)
5515 elf_section_data (s)->local_dynrel);
5516 p != NULL;
5517 p = p->next)
5518 {
5519 if (!bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec)
5520 && bfd_is_abs_section (p->sec->output_section))
5521 {
5522 /* Input section has been discarded, either because
5523 it is a copy of a linkonce section or due to
5524 linker script /DISCARD/, so we'll be discarding
5525 the relocs too. */
5526 }
5527 else if (htab->is_vxworks
5528 && strcmp (p->sec->output_section->name,
5529 ".tls_vars") == 0)
5530 {
5531 /* Relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections are
5532 handled specially by the loader. */
5533 }
5534 else if (p->count != 0)
5535 {
5536 asection *sreloc = elf_section_data (p->sec)->sreloc;
5537 if (p->ifunc)
5538 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
5539 sreloc->size += p->count * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5540 if ((p->sec->output_section->flags
5541 & (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5542 == (SEC_READONLY | SEC_ALLOC))
5543 {
5544 info->flags |= DF_TEXTREL;
5545 info->callbacks->minfo (_("%pB: dynamic relocation in read-only section `%pA'\n"),
5546 p->sec->owner, p->sec);
5547 }
5548 }
5549 }
5550 }
5551
5552 local_got = elf_local_got_refcounts (ibfd);
5553 if (!local_got)
5554 continue;
5555
5556 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
5557 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
5558 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
5559 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
5560 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
5561 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5562
5563 for (; local_got < end_local_got; ++local_got, ++lgot_masks)
5564 if (*local_got > 0)
5565 {
5566 unsigned int need;
5567 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)) == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
5568 htab->tlsld_got.refcount += 1;
5569 need = got_entries_needed (*lgot_masks);
5570 if (need == 0)
5571 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5572 else
5573 {
5574 *local_got = allocate_got (htab, need);
5575 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5576 && !((*lgot_masks & TLS_TLS) != 0
5577 && bfd_link_executable (info)))
5578 {
5579 asection *srel;
5580
5581 need *= sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4;
5582 srel = htab->elf.srelgot;
5583 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5584 srel = htab->elf.irelplt;
5585 srel->size += need;
5586 }
5587 }
5588 }
5589 else
5590 *local_got = (bfd_vma) -1;
5591
5592 if (htab->is_vxworks)
5593 continue;
5594
5595 /* Allocate space for calls to local STT_GNU_IFUNC syms in .iplt. */
5596 lgot_masks = (char *) end_local_plt;
5597 for (; local_plt < end_local_plt; ++local_plt, ++lgot_masks)
5598 {
5599 struct plt_entry *ent;
5600 bfd_boolean doneone = FALSE;
5601 bfd_vma plt_offset = 0, glink_offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5602
5603 for (ent = *local_plt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
5604 if (ent->plt.refcount > 0)
5605 {
5606 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5607 s = htab->elf.iplt;
5608 else if (htab->can_convert_all_inline_plt
5609 || (*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_KEEP)) != PLT_KEEP)
5610 {
5611 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5612 continue;
5613 }
5614 else
5615 s = htab->pltlocal;
5616
5617 if (!doneone)
5618 {
5619 plt_offset = s->size;
5620 s->size += 4;
5621 }
5622 ent->plt.offset = plt_offset;
5623
5624 if (s != htab->pltlocal && (!doneone || bfd_link_pic (info)))
5625 {
5626 s = htab->glink;
5627 glink_offset = s->size;
5628 s->size += GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, NULL);
5629 }
5630 ent->glink_offset = glink_offset;
5631
5632 if (!doneone)
5633 {
5634 if ((*lgot_masks & (TLS_TLS | PLT_IFUNC)) == PLT_IFUNC)
5635 {
5636 s = htab->elf.irelplt;
5637 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5638 }
5639 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5640 {
5641 s = htab->relpltlocal;
5642 s->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5643 }
5644 doneone = TRUE;
5645 }
5646 }
5647 else
5648 ent->plt.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5649 }
5650 }
5651
5652 /* Allocate space for global sym dynamic relocs. */
5653 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), allocate_dynrelocs, info);
5654
5655 if (htab->tlsld_got.refcount > 0)
5656 {
5657 htab->tlsld_got.offset = allocate_got (htab, 8);
5658 if (bfd_link_dll (info))
5659 htab->elf.srelgot->size += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
5660 }
5661 else
5662 htab->tlsld_got.offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
5663
5664 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL && htab->plt_type != PLT_VXWORKS)
5665 {
5666 unsigned int g_o_t = 32768;
5667
5668 /* If we haven't allocated the header, do so now. When we get here,
5669 for old plt/got the got size will be 0 to 32764 (not allocated),
5670 or 32780 to 65536 (header allocated). For new plt/got, the
5671 corresponding ranges are 0 to 32768 and 32780 to 65536. */
5672 if (htab->elf.sgot->size <= 32768)
5673 {
5674 g_o_t = htab->elf.sgot->size;
5675 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
5676 g_o_t += 4;
5677 htab->elf.sgot->size += htab->got_header_size;
5678 }
5679
5680 htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value = g_o_t;
5681 }
5682 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5683 {
5684 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5685
5686 sda->root.u.def.section = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section;
5687 sda->root.u.def.value = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
5688 }
5689 if (info->emitrelocations)
5690 {
5691 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
5692
5693 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5694 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5695 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
5696 if (sda != NULL && sda->ref_regular)
5697 sda->root.u.def.section->flags |= SEC_KEEP;
5698 }
5699
5700 if (htab->glink != NULL
5701 && htab->glink->size != 0
5702 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5703 {
5704 htab->glink_pltresolve = htab->glink->size;
5705 /* Space for the branch table. */
5706 htab->glink->size
5707 += htab->elf.srelplt->size / (sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela) / 4) - 4;
5708 /* Pad out to align the start of PLTresolve. */
5709 htab->glink->size += -htab->glink->size & (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
5710 ? 63 : 15);
5711 htab->glink->size += GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5712
5713 if (htab->params->emit_stub_syms)
5714 {
5715 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sh;
5716 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink",
5717 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5718 if (sh == NULL)
5719 return FALSE;
5720 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5721 {
5722 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5723 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5724 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink_pltresolve;
5725 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5726 sh->def_regular = 1;
5727 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5728 sh->forced_local = 1;
5729 sh->non_elf = 0;
5730 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5731 }
5732 sh = elf_link_hash_lookup (&htab->elf, "__glink_PLTresolve",
5733 TRUE, FALSE, FALSE);
5734 if (sh == NULL)
5735 return FALSE;
5736 if (sh->root.type == bfd_link_hash_new)
5737 {
5738 sh->root.type = bfd_link_hash_defined;
5739 sh->root.u.def.section = htab->glink;
5740 sh->root.u.def.value = htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
5741 sh->ref_regular = 1;
5742 sh->def_regular = 1;
5743 sh->ref_regular_nonweak = 1;
5744 sh->forced_local = 1;
5745 sh->non_elf = 0;
5746 sh->root.linker_def = 1;
5747 }
5748 }
5749 }
5750
5751 if (htab->glink != NULL
5752 && htab->glink->size != 0
5753 && htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5754 && !bfd_is_abs_section (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section)
5755 && _bfd_elf_eh_frame_present (info))
5756 {
5757 s = htab->glink_eh_frame;
5758 s->size = sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) + 20;
5759 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
5760 {
5761 s->size += 4;
5762 if (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8 >= 256)
5763 s->size += 4;
5764 }
5765 }
5766
5767 /* We've now determined the sizes of the various dynamic sections.
5768 Allocate memory for them. */
5769 relocs = FALSE;
5770 for (s = htab->elf.dynobj->sections; s != NULL; s = s->next)
5771 {
5772 bfd_boolean strip_section = TRUE;
5773
5774 if ((s->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) == 0)
5775 continue;
5776
5777 if (s == htab->elf.splt
5778 || s == htab->elf.sgot)
5779 {
5780 /* We'd like to strip these sections if they aren't needed, but if
5781 we've exported dynamic symbols from them we must leave them.
5782 It's too late to tell BFD to get rid of the symbols. */
5783 if (htab->elf.hplt != NULL)
5784 strip_section = FALSE;
5785 /* Strip this section if we don't need it; see the
5786 comment below. */
5787 }
5788 else if (s == htab->elf.iplt
5789 || s == htab->pltlocal
5790 || s == htab->glink
5791 || s == htab->glink_eh_frame
5792 || s == htab->elf.sgotplt
5793 || s == htab->sbss
5794 || s == htab->elf.sdynbss
5795 || s == htab->elf.sdynrelro
5796 || s == htab->dynsbss)
5797 {
5798 /* Strip these too. */
5799 }
5800 else if (s == htab->sdata[0].section
5801 || s == htab->sdata[1].section)
5802 {
5803 strip_section = (s->flags & SEC_KEEP) == 0;
5804 }
5805 else if (CONST_STRNEQ (bfd_section_name (s), ".rela"))
5806 {
5807 if (s->size != 0)
5808 {
5809 /* Remember whether there are any relocation sections. */
5810 relocs = TRUE;
5811
5812 /* We use the reloc_count field as a counter if we need
5813 to copy relocs into the output file. */
5814 s->reloc_count = 0;
5815 }
5816 }
5817 else
5818 {
5819 /* It's not one of our sections, so don't allocate space. */
5820 continue;
5821 }
5822
5823 if (s->size == 0 && strip_section)
5824 {
5825 /* If we don't need this section, strip it from the
5826 output file. This is mostly to handle .rela.bss and
5827 .rela.plt. We must create both sections in
5828 create_dynamic_sections, because they must be created
5829 before the linker maps input sections to output
5830 sections. The linker does that before
5831 adjust_dynamic_symbol is called, and it is that
5832 function which decides whether anything needs to go
5833 into these sections. */
5834 s->flags |= SEC_EXCLUDE;
5835 continue;
5836 }
5837
5838 if ((s->flags & SEC_HAS_CONTENTS) == 0)
5839 continue;
5840
5841 /* Allocate memory for the section contents. */
5842 s->contents = bfd_zalloc (htab->elf.dynobj, s->size);
5843 if (s->contents == NULL)
5844 return FALSE;
5845 }
5846
5847 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5848 {
5849 /* Add some entries to the .dynamic section. We fill in the
5850 values later, in ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections, but we
5851 must add the entries now so that we get the correct size for
5852 the .dynamic section. The DT_DEBUG entry is filled in by the
5853 dynamic linker and used by the debugger. */
5854 #define add_dynamic_entry(TAG, VAL) \
5855 _bfd_elf_add_dynamic_entry (info, TAG, VAL)
5856
5857 if (bfd_link_executable (info))
5858 {
5859 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_DEBUG, 0))
5860 return FALSE;
5861 }
5862
5863 if (htab->elf.splt != NULL && htab->elf.splt->size != 0)
5864 {
5865 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTGOT, 0)
5866 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTRELSZ, 0)
5867 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PLTREL, DT_RELA)
5868 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_JMPREL, 0))
5869 return FALSE;
5870 }
5871
5872 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
5873 && htab->glink != NULL
5874 && htab->glink->size != 0)
5875 {
5876 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_GOT, 0))
5877 return FALSE;
5878 if (!htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt
5879 && htab->tls_get_addr != NULL
5880 && htab->tls_get_addr->plt.plist != NULL
5881 && !add_dynamic_entry (DT_PPC_OPT, PPC_OPT_TLS))
5882 return FALSE;
5883 }
5884
5885 if (relocs)
5886 {
5887 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELA, 0)
5888 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELASZ, 0)
5889 || !add_dynamic_entry (DT_RELAENT, sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela)))
5890 return FALSE;
5891 }
5892
5893 /* If any dynamic relocs apply to a read-only section, then we
5894 need a DT_TEXTREL entry. */
5895 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) == 0)
5896 elf_link_hash_traverse (elf_hash_table (info), maybe_set_textrel,
5897 info);
5898
5899 if ((info->flags & DF_TEXTREL) != 0)
5900 {
5901 if (!add_dynamic_entry (DT_TEXTREL, 0))
5902 return FALSE;
5903 }
5904 if (htab->is_vxworks
5905 && !elf_vxworks_add_dynamic_entries (output_bfd, info))
5906 return FALSE;
5907 }
5908 #undef add_dynamic_entry
5909
5910 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
5911 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
5912 {
5913 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5914 bfd_vma val;
5915
5916 memcpy (p, glink_eh_frame_cie, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie));
5917 /* CIE length (rewrite in case little-endian). */
5918 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie) - 4, p);
5919 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5920 /* FDE length. */
5921 val = htab->glink_eh_frame->size - 4 - sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
5922 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5923 p += 4;
5924 /* CIE pointer. */
5925 val = p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
5926 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
5927 p += 4;
5928 /* Offset to .glink. Set later. */
5929 p += 4;
5930 /* .glink size. */
5931 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, htab->glink->size, p);
5932 p += 4;
5933 /* Augmentation. */
5934 p += 1;
5935
5936 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
5937 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
5938 {
5939 bfd_vma adv = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 8) >> 2;
5940 if (adv < 64)
5941 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + adv;
5942 else if (adv < 256)
5943 {
5944 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc1;
5945 *p++ = adv;
5946 }
5947 else if (adv < 65536)
5948 {
5949 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc2;
5950 bfd_put_16 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5951 p += 2;
5952 }
5953 else
5954 {
5955 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc4;
5956 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, adv, p);
5957 p += 4;
5958 }
5959 *p++ = DW_CFA_register;
5960 *p++ = 65;
5961 p++;
5962 *p++ = DW_CFA_advance_loc + 4;
5963 *p++ = DW_CFA_restore_extended;
5964 *p++ = 65;
5965 }
5966 BFD_ASSERT ((bfd_vma) ((p + 3 - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents) & -4)
5967 == htab->glink_eh_frame->size);
5968 }
5969
5970 return TRUE;
5971 }
5972
5973 /* Arrange to have _SDA_BASE_ or _SDA2_BASE_ stripped from the output
5974 if it looks like nothing is using them. */
5975
5976 static void
5977 maybe_strip_sdasym (bfd *output_bfd, elf_linker_section_t *lsect)
5978 {
5979 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = lsect->sym;
5980
5981 if (sda != NULL && !sda->ref_regular && sda->dynindx == -1)
5982 {
5983 asection *s;
5984
5985 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->name);
5986 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
5987 {
5988 s = bfd_get_section_by_name (output_bfd, lsect->bss_name);
5989 if (s == NULL || bfd_section_removed_from_list (output_bfd, s))
5990 {
5991 sda->def_regular = 0;
5992 /* This is somewhat magic. See elf_link_output_extsym. */
5993 sda->ref_dynamic = 1;
5994 sda->forced_local = 0;
5995 }
5996 }
5997 }
5998 }
5999
6000 void
6001 ppc_elf_maybe_strip_sdata_syms (struct bfd_link_info *info)
6002 {
6003 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6004
6005 if (htab != NULL)
6006 {
6007 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[0]);
6008 maybe_strip_sdasym (info->output_bfd, &htab->sdata[1]);
6009 }
6010 }
6011
6012
6013 /* Return TRUE if symbol should be hashed in the `.gnu.hash' section. */
6014
6015 static bfd_boolean
6016 ppc_elf_hash_symbol (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6017 {
6018 if (h->plt.plist != NULL
6019 && !h->def_regular
6020 && (!h->pointer_equality_needed
6021 || !h->ref_regular_nonweak))
6022 return FALSE;
6023
6024 return _bfd_elf_hash_symbol (h);
6025 }
6026 \f
6027 #define ARRAY_SIZE(a) (sizeof (a) / sizeof ((a)[0]))
6028
6029 /* Relaxation trampolines. r12 is available for clobbering (r11, is
6030 used for some functions that are allowed to break the ABI). */
6031 static const int shared_stub_entry[] =
6032 {
6033 0x7c0802a6, /* mflr 0 */
6034 0x429f0005, /* bcl 20, 31, .Lxxx */
6035 0x7d8802a6, /* mflr 12 */
6036 0x3d8c0000, /* addis 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@ha */
6037 0x398c0000, /* addi 12, 12, (xxx-.Lxxx)@l */
6038 0x7c0803a6, /* mtlr 0 */
6039 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6040 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6041 };
6042
6043 static const int stub_entry[] =
6044 {
6045 0x3d800000, /* lis 12,xxx@ha */
6046 0x398c0000, /* addi 12,12,xxx@l */
6047 0x7d8903a6, /* mtctr 12 */
6048 0x4e800420, /* bctr */
6049 };
6050
6051 struct ppc_elf_relax_info
6052 {
6053 unsigned int workaround_size;
6054 unsigned int picfixup_size;
6055 };
6056
6057 /* This function implements long branch trampolines, and the ppc476
6058 icache bug workaround. Any section needing trampolines or patch
6059 space for the workaround has its size extended so that we can
6060 add trampolines at the end of the section. */
6061
6062 static bfd_boolean
6063 ppc_elf_relax_section (bfd *abfd,
6064 asection *isec,
6065 struct bfd_link_info *link_info,
6066 bfd_boolean *again)
6067 {
6068 struct one_branch_fixup
6069 {
6070 struct one_branch_fixup *next;
6071 asection *tsec;
6072 /* Final link, can use the symbol offset. For a
6073 relocatable link we use the symbol's index. */
6074 bfd_vma toff;
6075 bfd_vma trampoff;
6076 };
6077
6078 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6079 bfd_byte *contents = NULL;
6080 Elf_Internal_Sym *isymbuf = NULL;
6081 Elf_Internal_Rela *internal_relocs = NULL;
6082 Elf_Internal_Rela *irel, *irelend = NULL;
6083 struct one_branch_fixup *branch_fixups = NULL;
6084 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6085 unsigned changes = 0;
6086 bfd_boolean workaround_change;
6087 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6088 bfd_size_type trampbase, trampoff, newsize, picfixup_size;
6089 asection *got2;
6090 bfd_boolean maybe_pasted;
6091
6092 *again = FALSE;
6093
6094 /* No need to do anything with non-alloc or non-code sections. */
6095 if ((isec->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
6096 || (isec->flags & SEC_CODE) == 0
6097 || (isec->flags & SEC_LINKER_CREATED) != 0
6098 || isec->size < 4)
6099 return TRUE;
6100
6101 /* We cannot represent the required PIC relocs in the output, so don't
6102 do anything. The linker doesn't support mixing -shared and -r
6103 anyway. */
6104 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6105 return TRUE;
6106
6107 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (link_info);
6108 if (htab == NULL)
6109 return TRUE;
6110
6111 isec->size = (isec->size + 3) & -4;
6112 if (isec->rawsize == 0)
6113 isec->rawsize = isec->size;
6114 trampbase = isec->size;
6115
6116 BFD_ASSERT (isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_NONE
6117 || isec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET);
6118 isec->sec_info_type = SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET;
6119
6120 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6121 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6122 {
6123 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6124 {
6125 elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info
6126 = bfd_zalloc (abfd, sizeof (struct ppc_elf_relax_info));
6127 if (elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info == NULL)
6128 return FALSE;
6129 }
6130 relax_info = elf_section_data (isec)->sec_info;
6131 trampbase -= relax_info->workaround_size;
6132 }
6133
6134 maybe_pasted = (strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
6135 || strcmp (isec->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0);
6136 /* Space for a branch around any trampolines. */
6137 trampoff = trampbase;
6138 if (maybe_pasted && trampbase == isec->rawsize)
6139 trampoff += 4;
6140
6141 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (abfd);
6142 picfixup_size = 0;
6143 if (htab->params->branch_trampolines
6144 || htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6145 {
6146 /* Get a copy of the native relocations. */
6147 if (isec->reloc_count != 0)
6148 {
6149 internal_relocs = _bfd_elf_link_read_relocs (abfd, isec, NULL, NULL,
6150 link_info->keep_memory);
6151 if (internal_relocs == NULL)
6152 goto error_return;
6153 }
6154
6155 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (abfd, ".got2");
6156
6157 irelend = internal_relocs + isec->reloc_count;
6158 for (irel = internal_relocs; irel < irelend; irel++)
6159 {
6160 unsigned long r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel->r_info);
6161 bfd_vma toff, roff;
6162 asection *tsec;
6163 struct one_branch_fixup *f;
6164 size_t insn_offset = 0;
6165 bfd_vma max_branch_offset = 0, val;
6166 bfd_byte *hit_addr;
6167 unsigned long t0;
6168 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
6169 Elf_Internal_Sym *isym;
6170 struct plt_entry **plist;
6171 unsigned char sym_type;
6172
6173 switch (r_type)
6174 {
6175 case R_PPC_REL24:
6176 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6177 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6178 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
6179 max_branch_offset = 1 << 25;
6180 break;
6181
6182 case R_PPC_REL14:
6183 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6184 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6185 max_branch_offset = 1 << 15;
6186 break;
6187
6188 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
6189 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6190 break;
6191 continue;
6192
6193 default:
6194 continue;
6195 }
6196
6197 /* Get the value of the symbol referred to by the reloc. */
6198 if (!get_sym_h (&h, &isym, &tsec, NULL, &isymbuf,
6199 ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info), abfd))
6200 goto error_return;
6201
6202 if (isym != NULL)
6203 {
6204 if (tsec != NULL)
6205 ;
6206 else if (isym->st_shndx == SHN_ABS)
6207 tsec = bfd_abs_section_ptr;
6208 else
6209 continue;
6210
6211 toff = isym->st_value;
6212 sym_type = ELF_ST_TYPE (isym->st_info);
6213 }
6214 else
6215 {
6216 if (tsec != NULL)
6217 toff = h->root.u.def.value;
6218 else if (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined
6219 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak)
6220 {
6221 unsigned long indx;
6222
6223 indx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info) - symtab_hdr->sh_info;
6224 tsec = bfd_und_section_ptr;
6225 toff = bfd_link_relocatable (link_info) ? indx : 0;
6226 }
6227 else
6228 continue;
6229
6230 /* If this branch is to __tls_get_addr then we may later
6231 optimise away the call. We won't be needing a long-
6232 branch stub in that case. */
6233 if (bfd_link_executable (link_info)
6234 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6235 && irel != internal_relocs)
6236 {
6237 unsigned long t_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (irel[-1].r_info);
6238 unsigned long t_rtype = ELF32_R_TYPE (irel[-1].r_info);
6239 unsigned int tls_mask = 0;
6240
6241 /* The previous reloc should be one of R_PPC_TLSGD or
6242 R_PPC_TLSLD, or for older object files, a reloc
6243 on the __tls_get_addr arg setup insn. Get tls
6244 mask bits from the symbol on that reloc. */
6245 if (t_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
6246 {
6247 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6248
6249 if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
6250 {
6251 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6252 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6253 char *lgot_masks = (char *)
6254 (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6255 tls_mask = lgot_masks[t_symndx];
6256 }
6257 }
6258 else
6259 {
6260 struct elf_link_hash_entry *th
6261 = elf_sym_hashes (abfd)[t_symndx - symtab_hdr->sh_info];
6262
6263 while (th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_indirect
6264 || th->root.type == bfd_link_hash_warning)
6265 th = (struct elf_link_hash_entry *) th->root.u.i.link;
6266
6267 tls_mask
6268 = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) th)->tls_mask;
6269 }
6270
6271 /* The mask bits tell us if the call will be
6272 optimised away. */
6273 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
6274 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSGD
6275 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16
6276 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO))
6277 continue;
6278 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
6279 && (t_rtype == R_PPC_TLSLD
6280 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16
6281 || t_rtype == R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO))
6282 continue;
6283 }
6284
6285 sym_type = h->type;
6286 }
6287
6288 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
6289 {
6290 if (h != NULL
6291 && !h->def_regular
6292 && h->protected_def
6293 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
6294 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo)
6295 picfixup_size += 12;
6296 continue;
6297 }
6298
6299 /* The condition here under which we call find_plt_ent must
6300 match that in relocate_section. If we call find_plt_ent here
6301 but not in relocate_section, or vice versa, then the branch
6302 destination used here may be incorrect. */
6303 plist = NULL;
6304 if (h != NULL)
6305 {
6306 /* We know is_branch_reloc (r_type) is true. */
6307 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6308 || r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6309 plist = &h->plt.plist;
6310 }
6311 else if (sym_type == STT_GNU_IFUNC
6312 && elf_local_got_offsets (abfd) != NULL)
6313 {
6314 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (abfd);
6315 struct plt_entry **local_plt = (struct plt_entry **)
6316 (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
6317 plist = local_plt + ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info);
6318 }
6319 if (plist != NULL)
6320 {
6321 bfd_vma addend = 0;
6322 struct plt_entry *ent;
6323
6324 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24 && bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6325 addend = irel->r_addend;
6326 ent = find_plt_ent (plist, got2, addend);
6327 if (ent != NULL)
6328 {
6329 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
6330 || h == NULL
6331 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
6332 || h->dynindx == -1)
6333 {
6334 tsec = htab->glink;
6335 toff = ent->glink_offset;
6336 }
6337 else
6338 {
6339 tsec = htab->elf.splt;
6340 toff = ent->plt.offset;
6341 }
6342 }
6343 }
6344
6345 /* If the branch and target are in the same section, you have
6346 no hope of adding stubs. We'll error out later should the
6347 branch overflow. */
6348 if (tsec == isec)
6349 continue;
6350
6351 /* toff is used for the symbol index when the symbol is
6352 undefined and we're doing a relocatable link, so we can't
6353 support addends. It would be possible to do so by
6354 putting the addend in one_branch_fixup but addends on
6355 branches are rare so it hardly seems worth supporting. */
6356 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6357 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr
6358 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24
6359 && irel->r_addend != 0)
6360 continue;
6361
6362 /* There probably isn't any reason to handle symbols in
6363 SEC_MERGE sections; SEC_MERGE doesn't seem a likely
6364 attribute for a code section, and we are only looking at
6365 branches. However, implement it correctly here as a
6366 reference for other target relax_section functions. */
6367 if (0 && tsec->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_MERGE)
6368 {
6369 /* At this stage in linking, no SEC_MERGE symbol has been
6370 adjusted, so all references to such symbols need to be
6371 passed through _bfd_merged_section_offset. (Later, in
6372 relocate_section, all SEC_MERGE symbols *except* for
6373 section symbols have been adjusted.)
6374
6375 gas may reduce relocations against symbols in SEC_MERGE
6376 sections to a relocation against the section symbol when
6377 the original addend was zero. When the reloc is against
6378 a section symbol we should include the addend in the
6379 offset passed to _bfd_merged_section_offset, since the
6380 location of interest is the original symbol. On the
6381 other hand, an access to "sym+addend" where "sym" is not
6382 a section symbol should not include the addend; Such an
6383 access is presumed to be an offset from "sym"; The
6384 location of interest is just "sym". */
6385 if (sym_type == STT_SECTION
6386 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6387 toff += irel->r_addend;
6388
6389 toff
6390 = _bfd_merged_section_offset (abfd, &tsec,
6391 elf_section_data (tsec)->sec_info,
6392 toff);
6393
6394 if (sym_type != STT_SECTION
6395 && r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6396 toff += irel->r_addend;
6397 }
6398 /* PLTREL24 addends are special. */
6399 else if (r_type != R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6400 toff += irel->r_addend;
6401
6402 /* Attempted -shared link of non-pic code loses. */
6403 if ((!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6404 && tsec == bfd_und_section_ptr)
6405 || tsec->output_section == NULL
6406 || (tsec->owner != NULL
6407 && (tsec->owner->flags & BFD_PLUGIN) != 0))
6408 continue;
6409
6410 roff = irel->r_offset;
6411
6412 /* Avoid creating a lot of unnecessary fixups when
6413 relocatable if the output section size is such that a
6414 fixup can be created at final link.
6415 The max_branch_offset adjustment allows for some number
6416 of other fixups being needed at final link. */
6417 if (bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6418 && (isec->output_section->rawsize - (isec->output_offset + roff)
6419 < max_branch_offset - (max_branch_offset >> 4)))
6420 continue;
6421
6422 /* If the branch is in range, no need to do anything. */
6423 if (tsec != bfd_und_section_ptr
6424 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6425 /* A relocatable link may have sections moved during
6426 final link, so do not presume they remain in range. */
6427 || tsec->output_section == isec->output_section))
6428 {
6429 bfd_vma symaddr, reladdr;
6430
6431 symaddr = tsec->output_section->vma + tsec->output_offset + toff;
6432 reladdr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset + roff;
6433 if (symaddr - reladdr + max_branch_offset
6434 < 2 * max_branch_offset)
6435 continue;
6436 }
6437
6438 /* Look for an existing fixup to this address. */
6439 for (f = branch_fixups; f ; f = f->next)
6440 if (f->tsec == tsec && f->toff == toff)
6441 break;
6442
6443 if (f == NULL)
6444 {
6445 size_t size;
6446 unsigned long stub_rtype;
6447
6448 val = trampoff - roff;
6449 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6450 /* Oh dear, we can't reach a trampoline. Don't try to add
6451 one. We'll report an error later. */
6452 continue;
6453
6454 if (bfd_link_pic (link_info))
6455 {
6456 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry);
6457 insn_offset = 12;
6458 }
6459 else
6460 {
6461 size = 4 * ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
6462 insn_offset = 0;
6463 }
6464 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX;
6465 if (tsec == htab->elf.splt
6466 || tsec == htab->glink)
6467 {
6468 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLT;
6469 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24)
6470 stub_rtype = R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24;
6471 }
6472
6473 /* Hijack the old relocation. Since we need two
6474 relocations for this use a "composite" reloc. */
6475 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (ELF32_R_SYM (irel->r_info),
6476 stub_rtype);
6477 irel->r_offset = trampoff + insn_offset;
6478 if (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
6479 && stub_rtype != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
6480 irel->r_addend = 0;
6481
6482 /* Record the fixup so we don't do it again this section. */
6483 f = bfd_malloc (sizeof (*f));
6484 f->next = branch_fixups;
6485 f->tsec = tsec;
6486 f->toff = toff;
6487 f->trampoff = trampoff;
6488 branch_fixups = f;
6489
6490 trampoff += size;
6491 changes++;
6492 }
6493 else
6494 {
6495 val = f->trampoff - roff;
6496 if (val >= max_branch_offset)
6497 continue;
6498
6499 /* Nop out the reloc, since we're finalizing things here. */
6500 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6501 }
6502
6503 /* Get the section contents. */
6504 if (contents == NULL)
6505 {
6506 /* Get cached copy if it exists. */
6507 if (elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != NULL)
6508 contents = elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents;
6509 /* Go get them off disk. */
6510 else if (!bfd_malloc_and_get_section (abfd, isec, &contents))
6511 goto error_return;
6512 }
6513
6514 /* Fix up the existing branch to hit the trampoline. */
6515 hit_addr = contents + roff;
6516 switch (r_type)
6517 {
6518 case R_PPC_REL24:
6519 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
6520 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
6521 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6522 t0 &= ~0x3fffffc;
6523 t0 |= val & 0x3fffffc;
6524 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6525 break;
6526
6527 case R_PPC_REL14:
6528 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
6529 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
6530 t0 = bfd_get_32 (abfd, hit_addr);
6531 t0 &= ~0xfffc;
6532 t0 |= val & 0xfffc;
6533 bfd_put_32 (abfd, t0, hit_addr);
6534 break;
6535 }
6536 }
6537
6538 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6539 {
6540 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6541 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6542 free (f);
6543 }
6544 }
6545
6546 workaround_change = FALSE;
6547 newsize = trampoff;
6548 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
6549 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (link_info)
6550 || isec->output_section->alignment_power >= htab->params->pagesize_p2))
6551 {
6552 bfd_vma addr, end_addr;
6553 unsigned int crossings;
6554 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6555
6556 addr = isec->output_section->vma + isec->output_offset;
6557 end_addr = addr + trampoff;
6558 addr &= -pagesize;
6559 crossings = ((end_addr & -pagesize) - addr) >> htab->params->pagesize_p2;
6560 if (crossings != 0)
6561 {
6562 /* Keep space aligned, to ensure the patch code itself does
6563 not cross a page. Don't decrease size calculated on a
6564 previous pass as otherwise we might never settle on a layout. */
6565 newsize = 15 - ((end_addr - 1) & 15);
6566 newsize += crossings * 16;
6567 if (relax_info->workaround_size < newsize)
6568 {
6569 relax_info->workaround_size = newsize;
6570 workaround_change = TRUE;
6571 }
6572 /* Ensure relocate_section is called. */
6573 isec->flags |= SEC_RELOC;
6574 }
6575 newsize = trampoff + relax_info->workaround_size;
6576 }
6577
6578 if (htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
6579 {
6580 picfixup_size -= relax_info->picfixup_size;
6581 if (picfixup_size != 0)
6582 relax_info->picfixup_size += picfixup_size;
6583 newsize += relax_info->picfixup_size;
6584 }
6585
6586 if (changes != 0 || picfixup_size != 0 || workaround_change)
6587 isec->size = newsize;
6588
6589 if (isymbuf != NULL
6590 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) isymbuf)
6591 {
6592 if (! link_info->keep_memory)
6593 free (isymbuf);
6594 else
6595 {
6596 /* Cache the symbols for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6597 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) isymbuf;
6598 }
6599 }
6600
6601 if (contents != NULL
6602 && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6603 {
6604 if (!changes && !link_info->keep_memory)
6605 free (contents);
6606 else
6607 {
6608 /* Cache the section contents for elf_link_input_bfd. */
6609 elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents = contents;
6610 }
6611 }
6612
6613 changes += picfixup_size;
6614 if (changes != 0)
6615 {
6616 /* Append sufficient NOP relocs so we can write out relocation
6617 information for the trampolines. */
6618 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
6619 Elf_Internal_Rela *new_relocs = bfd_malloc ((changes + isec->reloc_count)
6620 * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6621 unsigned ix;
6622
6623 if (!new_relocs)
6624 goto error_return;
6625 memcpy (new_relocs, internal_relocs,
6626 isec->reloc_count * sizeof (*new_relocs));
6627 for (ix = changes; ix--;)
6628 {
6629 irel = new_relocs + ix + isec->reloc_count;
6630
6631 irel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_NONE);
6632 }
6633 if (internal_relocs != elf_section_data (isec)->relocs)
6634 free (internal_relocs);
6635 elf_section_data (isec)->relocs = new_relocs;
6636 isec->reloc_count += changes;
6637 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (isec);
6638 rel_hdr->sh_size += changes * rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
6639 }
6640 else if (internal_relocs != NULL
6641 && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6642 free (internal_relocs);
6643
6644 *again = changes != 0 || workaround_change;
6645 return TRUE;
6646
6647 error_return:
6648 while (branch_fixups != NULL)
6649 {
6650 struct one_branch_fixup *f = branch_fixups;
6651 branch_fixups = branch_fixups->next;
6652 free (f);
6653 }
6654 if (isymbuf != NULL && (unsigned char *) isymbuf != symtab_hdr->contents)
6655 free (isymbuf);
6656 if (contents != NULL
6657 && elf_section_data (isec)->this_hdr.contents != contents)
6658 free (contents);
6659 if (internal_relocs != NULL
6660 && elf_section_data (isec)->relocs != internal_relocs)
6661 free (internal_relocs);
6662 return FALSE;
6663 }
6664 \f
6665 /* What to do when ld finds relocations against symbols defined in
6666 discarded sections. */
6667
6668 static unsigned int
6669 ppc_elf_action_discarded (asection *sec)
6670 {
6671 if (strcmp (".fixup", sec->name) == 0)
6672 return 0;
6673
6674 if (strcmp (".got2", sec->name) == 0)
6675 return 0;
6676
6677 return _bfd_elf_default_action_discarded (sec);
6678 }
6679 \f
6680 /* Fill in the address for a pointer generated in a linker section. */
6681
6682 static bfd_vma
6683 elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (bfd *input_bfd,
6684 elf_linker_section_t *lsect,
6685 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
6686 bfd_vma relocation,
6687 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rel)
6688 {
6689 elf_linker_section_pointers_t *linker_section_ptr;
6690
6691 BFD_ASSERT (lsect != NULL);
6692
6693 if (h != NULL)
6694 {
6695 /* Handle global symbol. */
6696 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *eh;
6697
6698 eh = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h;
6699 BFD_ASSERT (eh->elf.def_regular);
6700 linker_section_ptr = eh->linker_section_pointer;
6701 }
6702 else
6703 {
6704 /* Handle local symbol. */
6705 unsigned long r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
6706
6707 BFD_ASSERT (is_ppc_elf (input_bfd));
6708 BFD_ASSERT (elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd) != NULL);
6709 linker_section_ptr = elf_local_ptr_offsets (input_bfd)[r_symndx];
6710 }
6711
6712 linker_section_ptr = elf_find_pointer_linker_section (linker_section_ptr,
6713 rel->r_addend,
6714 lsect);
6715 BFD_ASSERT (linker_section_ptr != NULL);
6716
6717 /* Offset will always be a multiple of four, so use the bottom bit
6718 as a "written" flag. */
6719 if ((linker_section_ptr->offset & 1) == 0)
6720 {
6721 bfd_put_32 (lsect->section->owner,
6722 relocation + linker_section_ptr->addend,
6723 lsect->section->contents + linker_section_ptr->offset);
6724 linker_section_ptr->offset += 1;
6725 }
6726
6727 relocation = (lsect->section->output_section->vma
6728 + lsect->section->output_offset
6729 + linker_section_ptr->offset - 1
6730 - SYM_VAL (lsect->sym));
6731
6732 #ifdef DEBUG
6733 fprintf (stderr,
6734 "Finish pointer in linker section %s, offset = %ld (0x%lx)\n",
6735 lsect->name, (long) relocation, (long) relocation);
6736 #endif
6737
6738 return relocation;
6739 }
6740
6741 #define PPC_LO(v) ((v) & 0xffff)
6742 #define PPC_HI(v) (((v) >> 16) & 0xffff)
6743 #define PPC_HA(v) PPC_HI ((v) + 0x8000)
6744
6745 static void
6746 write_glink_stub (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, struct plt_entry *ent,
6747 asection *plt_sec, unsigned char *p,
6748 struct bfd_link_info *info)
6749 {
6750 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
6751 bfd *output_bfd = info->output_bfd;
6752 bfd_vma plt;
6753 unsigned char *end = p + GLINK_ENTRY_SIZE (htab, h);
6754
6755 if (h != NULL
6756 && h == htab->tls_get_addr
6757 && !htab->params->no_tls_get_addr_opt)
6758 {
6759 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_3, p);
6760 p += 4;
6761 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_3 + 4, p);
6762 p += 4;
6763 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_0_3, p);
6764 p += 4;
6765 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, CMPWI_11_0, p);
6766 p += 4;
6767 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_3_12_2, p);
6768 p += 4;
6769 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BEQLR, p);
6770 p += 4;
6771 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MR_3_0, p);
6772 p += 4;
6773 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
6774 p += 4;
6775 }
6776
6777 plt = ((ent->plt.offset & ~1)
6778 + plt_sec->output_section->vma
6779 + plt_sec->output_offset);
6780
6781 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
6782 {
6783 bfd_vma got = 0;
6784
6785 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
6786 got = (ent->addend
6787 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
6788 + ent->sec->output_offset);
6789 else if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
6790 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
6791
6792 plt -= got;
6793
6794 if (plt + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
6795 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_30 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6796 else
6797 {
6798 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_30 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6799 p += 4;
6800 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6801 }
6802 }
6803 else
6804 {
6805 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_11 + PPC_HA (plt), p);
6806 p += 4;
6807 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_11_11 + PPC_LO (plt), p);
6808 }
6809 p += 4;
6810 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_11, p);
6811 p += 4;
6812 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
6813 p += 4;
6814 while (p < end)
6815 {
6816 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
6817 p += 4;
6818 }
6819 }
6820
6821 /* Return true if symbol is defined statically. */
6822
6823 static bfd_boolean
6824 is_static_defined (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h)
6825 {
6826 return ((h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
6827 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak)
6828 && h->root.u.def.section != NULL
6829 && h->root.u.def.section->output_section != NULL);
6830 }
6831
6832 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tls operand, return
6833 the transformed insn for TLS optimisation, otherwise return 0. If
6834 REG is non-zero only match an insn with RB or RA equal to REG. */
6835
6836 unsigned int
6837 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6838 {
6839 unsigned int rtra;
6840
6841 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) != 31 << 26)
6842 return 0;
6843
6844 if (reg == 0 || ((insn >> 11) & 0x1f) == reg)
6845 rtra = insn & ((1 << 26) - (1 << 16));
6846 else if (((insn >> 16) & 0x1f) == reg)
6847 rtra = (insn & (0x1f << 21)) | ((insn & (0x1f << 11)) << 5);
6848 else
6849 return 0;
6850
6851 if ((insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == 266 << 1)
6852 /* add -> addi. */
6853 insn = 14 << 26;
6854 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 1)) == 23 << 1
6855 && ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 14 << 6
6856 || ((insn & (0x1f << 6)) >= 16 << 6
6857 && (insn & (0x1f << 6)) < 24 << 6)))
6858 /* load and store indexed -> dform. */
6859 insn = (32 | ((insn >> 6) & 0x1f)) << 26;
6860 else if ((insn & (((0x1a << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 21 << 1)
6861 /* ldx, ldux, stdx, stdux -> ld, ldu, std, stdu. */
6862 insn = ((58 | ((insn >> 6) & 4)) << 26) | ((insn >> 6) & 1);
6863 else if ((insn & (((0x1f << 5) | 0x1f) << 1)) == 341 << 1)
6864 /* lwax -> lwa. */
6865 insn = (58 << 26) | 2;
6866 else
6867 return 0;
6868 insn |= rtra;
6869 return insn;
6870 }
6871
6872 /* If INSN is an opcode that may be used with an @tprel operand, return
6873 the transformed insn for an undefined weak symbol, ie. with the
6874 thread pointer REG operand removed. Otherwise return 0. */
6875
6876 unsigned int
6877 _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (unsigned int insn, unsigned int reg)
6878 {
6879 if ((insn & (0x1f << 16)) == reg << 16
6880 && ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
6881 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 15u << 26 /* addis */
6882 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
6883 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
6884 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
6885 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
6886 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
6887 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
6888 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
6889 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
6890 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
6891 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
6892 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
6893 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
6894 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
6895 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
6896 && (insn & 3) != 1)
6897 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
6898 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3))))
6899 {
6900 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
6901 }
6902 else if ((insn & (0x1f << 21)) == reg << 21
6903 && ((insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori, oris */
6904 || (insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori,xoris */
6905 || (insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi,andis */))
6906 {
6907 insn &= ~(0x1f << 21);
6908 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 16)) << 5;
6909 if ((insn & (0x3e << 26)) == 26 << 26 /* xori,xoris */)
6910 insn -= 2 >> 26; /* convert to ori,oris */
6911 }
6912 else
6913 insn = 0;
6914 return insn;
6915 }
6916
6917 static bfd_boolean
6918 is_insn_ds_form (unsigned int insn)
6919 {
6920 return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* ld,ldu,lwa */
6921 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std,stdu,stq */
6922 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 57u << 26 /* lfdp */
6923 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 61u << 26 /* stfdp */);
6924 }
6925
6926 static bfd_boolean
6927 is_insn_dq_form (unsigned int insn)
6928 {
6929 return ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 56u << 26 /* lq */
6930 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (61u << 26) /* lxv, stxv */
6931 && (insn & 3) == 1));
6932 }
6933
6934 /* The RELOCATE_SECTION function is called by the ELF backend linker
6935 to handle the relocations for a section.
6936
6937 The relocs are always passed as Rela structures; if the section
6938 actually uses Rel structures, the r_addend field will always be
6939 zero.
6940
6941 This function is responsible for adjust the section contents as
6942 necessary, and (if using Rela relocs and generating a
6943 relocatable output file) adjusting the reloc addend as
6944 necessary.
6945
6946 This function does not have to worry about setting the reloc
6947 address or the reloc symbol index.
6948
6949 LOCAL_SYMS is a pointer to the swapped in local symbols.
6950
6951 LOCAL_SECTIONS is an array giving the section in the input file
6952 corresponding to the st_shndx field of each local symbol.
6953
6954 The global hash table entry for the global symbols can be found
6955 via elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd).
6956
6957 When generating relocatable output, this function must handle
6958 STB_LOCAL/STT_SECTION symbols specially. The output symbol is
6959 going to be the section symbol corresponding to the output
6960 section, which means that the addend must be adjusted
6961 accordingly. */
6962
6963 static bfd_boolean
6964 ppc_elf_relocate_section (bfd *output_bfd,
6965 struct bfd_link_info *info,
6966 bfd *input_bfd,
6967 asection *input_section,
6968 bfd_byte *contents,
6969 Elf_Internal_Rela *relocs,
6970 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms,
6971 asection **local_sections)
6972 {
6973 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
6974 struct elf_link_hash_entry **sym_hashes;
6975 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
6976 Elf_Internal_Rela *rel;
6977 Elf_Internal_Rela *wrel;
6978 Elf_Internal_Rela *relend;
6979 Elf_Internal_Rela outrel;
6980 asection *got2;
6981 bfd_vma *local_got_offsets;
6982 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
6983 bfd_vma d_offset = (bfd_big_endian (input_bfd) ? 2 : 0);
6984 bfd_boolean is_vxworks_tls;
6985 unsigned int picfixup_size = 0;
6986 struct ppc_elf_relax_info *relax_info = NULL;
6987
6988 #ifdef DEBUG
6989 _bfd_error_handler ("ppc_elf_relocate_section called for %pB section %pA, "
6990 "%ld relocations%s",
6991 input_bfd, input_section,
6992 (long) input_section->reloc_count,
6993 (bfd_link_relocatable (info)) ? " (relocatable)" : "");
6994 #endif
6995
6996 if (!is_ppc_elf (input_bfd))
6997 {
6998 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_wrong_format);
6999 return FALSE;
7000 }
7001
7002 got2 = bfd_get_section_by_name (input_bfd, ".got2");
7003
7004 /* Initialize howto table if not already done. */
7005 if (!ppc_elf_howto_table[R_PPC_ADDR32])
7006 ppc_elf_howto_init ();
7007
7008 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
7009 local_got_offsets = elf_local_got_offsets (input_bfd);
7010 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (input_bfd);
7011 sym_hashes = elf_sym_hashes (input_bfd);
7012 /* We have to handle relocations in vxworks .tls_vars sections
7013 specially, because the dynamic loader is 'weird'. */
7014 is_vxworks_tls = (htab->is_vxworks && bfd_link_pic (info)
7015 && !strcmp (input_section->output_section->name,
7016 ".tls_vars"));
7017 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET)
7018 relax_info = elf_section_data (input_section)->sec_info;
7019 rel = wrel = relocs;
7020 relend = relocs + input_section->reloc_count;
7021 for (; rel < relend; wrel++, rel++)
7022 {
7023 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
7024 bfd_vma addend;
7025 bfd_reloc_status_type r;
7026 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
7027 asection *sec;
7028 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h;
7029 const char *sym_name;
7030 reloc_howto_type *howto;
7031 unsigned long r_symndx;
7032 bfd_vma relocation;
7033 bfd_vma branch_bit, from;
7034 bfd_boolean unresolved_reloc, save_unresolved_reloc;
7035 bfd_boolean warned;
7036 unsigned int tls_type, tls_mask, tls_gd;
7037 struct plt_entry **ifunc, **plt_list;
7038 struct reloc_howto_struct alt_howto;
7039
7040 again:
7041 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info);
7042 sym = NULL;
7043 sec = NULL;
7044 h = NULL;
7045 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7046 warned = FALSE;
7047 r_symndx = ELF32_R_SYM (rel->r_info);
7048
7049 if (r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7050 {
7051 sym = local_syms + r_symndx;
7052 sec = local_sections[r_symndx];
7053 sym_name = bfd_elf_sym_name (input_bfd, symtab_hdr, sym, sec);
7054
7055 relocation = _bfd_elf_rela_local_sym (output_bfd, sym, &sec, rel);
7056 }
7057 else
7058 {
7059 bfd_boolean ignored;
7060
7061 RELOC_FOR_GLOBAL_SYMBOL (info, input_bfd, input_section, rel,
7062 r_symndx, symtab_hdr, sym_hashes,
7063 h, sec, relocation,
7064 unresolved_reloc, warned, ignored);
7065
7066 sym_name = h->root.root.string;
7067 }
7068
7069 if (sec != NULL && discarded_section (sec))
7070 {
7071 /* For relocs against symbols from removed linkonce sections,
7072 or sections discarded by a linker script, we just want the
7073 section contents zeroed. Avoid any special processing. */
7074 howto = NULL;
7075 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7076 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7077
7078 _bfd_clear_contents (howto, input_bfd, input_section,
7079 contents, rel->r_offset);
7080 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset;
7081 wrel->r_info = 0;
7082 wrel->r_addend = 0;
7083
7084 /* For ld -r, remove relocations in debug sections against
7085 symbols defined in discarded sections. Not done for
7086 non-debug to preserve relocs in .eh_frame which the
7087 eh_frame editing code expects to be present. */
7088 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info)
7089 && (input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING))
7090 wrel--;
7091
7092 continue;
7093 }
7094
7095 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
7096 {
7097 if (got2 != NULL
7098 && r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7099 && rel->r_addend != 0)
7100 {
7101 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
7102 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2. */
7103 rel->r_addend += got2->output_offset;
7104 }
7105 if (r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLT
7106 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24
7107 && r_type != R_PPC_RELAX)
7108 goto copy_reloc;
7109 }
7110
7111 /* TLS optimizations. Replace instruction sequences and relocs
7112 based on information we collected in tls_optimize. We edit
7113 RELOCS so that --emit-relocs will output something sensible
7114 for the final instruction stream. */
7115 tls_mask = 0;
7116 tls_gd = 0;
7117 if (h != NULL)
7118 tls_mask = ((struct ppc_elf_link_hash_entry *) h)->tls_mask;
7119 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
7120 {
7121 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7122 char *lgot_masks;
7123 local_plt
7124 = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7125 lgot_masks = (char *) (local_plt + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7126 tls_mask = lgot_masks[r_symndx];
7127 }
7128
7129 /* Ensure reloc mapping code below stays sane. */
7130 if ((R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)
7131 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO & 3)
7132 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI & 3)
7133 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA & 3)
7134 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16 & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16 & 3)
7135 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO & 3)
7136 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI & 3)
7137 || (R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA & 3) != (R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA & 3))
7138 abort ();
7139 switch (r_type)
7140 {
7141 default:
7142 break;
7143
7144 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7145 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7146 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7147 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7148 {
7149 bfd_vma insn;
7150
7151 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7152 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7153 insn &= 31 << 21;
7154 insn |= 0x3c020000; /* addis 0,2,0 */
7155 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7156 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7157 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7158 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7159 }
7160 break;
7161
7162 case R_PPC_TLS:
7163 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7164 && (tls_mask & TLS_TPREL) == 0)
7165 {
7166 bfd_vma insn;
7167
7168 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7169 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tls_transform (insn, 2);
7170 if (insn == 0)
7171 abort ();
7172 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7173 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7174 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7175
7176 /* Was PPC_TLS which sits on insn boundary, now
7177 PPC_TPREL16_LO which is at low-order half-word. */
7178 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7179 }
7180 break;
7181
7182 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7183 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7184 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7185 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7186 goto tls_gdld_hi;
7187 break;
7188
7189 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7190 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7191 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7192 {
7193 tls_gdld_hi:
7194 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7195 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7196 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7197 else
7198 {
7199 rel->r_offset -= d_offset;
7200 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7201 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7202 }
7203 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7204 }
7205 break;
7206
7207 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7208 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7209 tls_gd = TLS_GDIE;
7210 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0)
7211 goto tls_ldgd_opt;
7212 break;
7213
7214 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7215 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7216 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0)
7217 {
7218 unsigned int insn1, insn2;
7219 bfd_vma offset;
7220
7221 tls_ldgd_opt:
7222 offset = (bfd_vma) -1;
7223 /* If not using the newer R_PPC_TLSGD/LD to mark
7224 __tls_get_addr calls, we must trust that the call
7225 stays with its arg setup insns, ie. that the next
7226 reloc is the __tls_get_addr call associated with
7227 the current reloc. Edit both insns. */
7228 if (input_section->nomark_tls_get_addr
7229 && rel + 1 < relend
7230 && branch_reloc_hash_match (input_bfd, rel + 1,
7231 htab->tls_get_addr))
7232 offset = rel[1].r_offset;
7233 /* We read the low GOT_TLS insn because we need to keep
7234 the destination reg. It may be something other than
7235 the usual r3, and moved to r3 before the call by
7236 intervening code. */
7237 insn1 = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7238 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7239 if ((tls_mask & tls_gd) != 0)
7240 {
7241 /* IE */
7242 insn1 &= (0x1f << 21) | (0x1f << 16);
7243 insn1 |= 32 << 26; /* lwz */
7244 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7245 {
7246 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7247 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7248 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7249 }
7250 r_type = (((r_type - (R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16 & 3)) & 3)
7251 + R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16);
7252 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7253 }
7254 else
7255 {
7256 /* LE */
7257 insn1 &= 0x1f << 21;
7258 insn1 |= 0x3c020000; /* addis r,2,0 */
7259 if (tls_gd == 0)
7260 {
7261 /* Was an LD reloc. */
7262 for (r_symndx = 0;
7263 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7264 r_symndx++)
7265 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7266 break;
7267 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7268 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7269 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7270 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7271 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7272 + sec->output_offset
7273 + sec->output_section->vma);
7274 }
7275 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_HA;
7276 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7277 if (offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
7278 {
7279 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7280 rel[1].r_offset = offset + d_offset;
7281 rel[1].r_addend = rel->r_addend;
7282 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7283 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7284 }
7285 }
7286 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn1,
7287 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7288 if (tls_gd == 0)
7289 {
7290 /* We changed the symbol on an LD reloc. Start over
7291 in order to get h, sym, sec etc. right. */
7292 goto again;
7293 }
7294 }
7295 break;
7296
7297 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7298 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_GD) == 0
7299 && rel + 1 < relend)
7300 {
7301 unsigned int insn2;
7302 bfd_vma offset = rel->r_offset;
7303
7304 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7305 {
7306 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + offset);
7307 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7308 break;
7309 }
7310
7311 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GDIE) != 0)
7312 {
7313 /* IE */
7314 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
7315 insn2 = 0x7c631214; /* add 3,3,2 */
7316 }
7317 else
7318 {
7319 /* LE */
7320 r_type = R_PPC_TPREL16_LO;
7321 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7322 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7323 }
7324 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, r_type);
7325 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2, contents + offset);
7326 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7327 BFD_ASSERT (offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7328 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7329 }
7330 break;
7331
7332 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7333 if ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0 && (tls_mask & TLS_LD) == 0
7334 && rel + 1 < relend)
7335 {
7336 unsigned int insn2;
7337
7338 if (is_plt_seq_reloc (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel[1].r_info)))
7339 {
7340 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, contents + rel->r_offset);
7341 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7342 break;
7343 }
7344
7345 for (r_symndx = 0;
7346 r_symndx < symtab_hdr->sh_info;
7347 r_symndx++)
7348 if (local_sections[r_symndx] == sec)
7349 break;
7350 if (r_symndx >= symtab_hdr->sh_info)
7351 r_symndx = STN_UNDEF;
7352 rel->r_addend = htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7353 if (r_symndx != STN_UNDEF)
7354 rel->r_addend -= (local_syms[r_symndx].st_value
7355 + sec->output_offset
7356 + sec->output_section->vma);
7357
7358 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_TPREL16_LO);
7359 rel->r_offset += d_offset;
7360 insn2 = 0x38630000; /* addi 3,3,0 */
7361 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn2,
7362 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7363 /* Zap the reloc on the _tls_get_addr call too. */
7364 BFD_ASSERT (rel->r_offset - d_offset == rel[1].r_offset);
7365 rel[1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (STN_UNDEF, R_PPC_NONE);
7366 goto again;
7367 }
7368 break;
7369 }
7370
7371 /* Handle other relocations that tweak non-addend part of insn. */
7372 branch_bit = 0;
7373 switch (r_type)
7374 {
7375 default:
7376 break;
7377
7378 /* Branch taken prediction relocations. */
7379 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
7380 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
7381 branch_bit = BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7382 /* Fall through. */
7383
7384 /* Branch not taken prediction relocations. */
7385 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
7386 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
7387 {
7388 unsigned int insn;
7389
7390 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
7391 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7392 insn |= branch_bit;
7393
7394 from = (rel->r_offset
7395 + input_section->output_offset
7396 + input_section->output_section->vma);
7397
7398 /* Invert 'y' bit if not the default. */
7399 if ((bfd_signed_vma) (relocation + rel->r_addend - from) < 0)
7400 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
7401
7402 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
7403 }
7404 break;
7405
7406 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
7407 {
7408 unsigned int insn;
7409
7410 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7411 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7412 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 15u << 26
7413 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) != 0)
7414 {
7415 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
7416 {
7417 /* Convert addis to lis. */
7418 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7419 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn,
7420 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7421 }
7422 }
7423 else if (bfd_link_pic (info))
7424 info->callbacks->einfo
7425 (_("%P: %H: error: %s with unexpected instruction %x\n"),
7426 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7427 "R_PPC_PLT16_HA", insn);
7428 }
7429 break;
7430 }
7431
7432 if (ELIMINATE_COPY_RELOCS
7433 && h != NULL
7434 && !h->def_regular
7435 && h->protected_def
7436 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_ha
7437 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_addr16_lo
7438 && htab->params->pic_fixup > 0)
7439 {
7440 /* Convert lis;addi or lis;load/store accessing a protected
7441 variable defined in a shared library to PIC. */
7442 unsigned int insn;
7443
7444 if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_HA)
7445 {
7446 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7447 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7448 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (15u << 26)
7449 && (insn & (0x1f << 16)) == 0 /* lis */)
7450 {
7451 bfd_byte *p;
7452 bfd_vma off;
7453 bfd_vma got_addr;
7454
7455 p = (contents + input_section->size
7456 - relax_info->workaround_size
7457 - relax_info->picfixup_size
7458 + picfixup_size);
7459 off = (p - contents) - (rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7460 if (off > 0x1fffffc || (off & 3) != 0)
7461 info->callbacks->einfo
7462 (_("%H: fixup branch overflow\n"),
7463 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
7464
7465 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | off,
7466 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7467 got_addr = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7468 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7469 + (h->got.offset & ~1));
7470 wrel->r_offset = (p - contents) + d_offset;
7471 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
7472 wrel->r_addend = got_addr;
7473 insn &= ~0xffff;
7474 insn |= ((unsigned int) (got_addr + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
7475 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7476
7477 /* Convert lis to lwz, loading address from GOT. */
7478 insn &= ~0xffff;
7479 insn ^= (32u ^ 15u) << 26;
7480 insn |= (insn & (0x1f << 21)) >> 5;
7481 insn |= got_addr & 0xffff;
7482 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p + 4);
7483
7484 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | ((-4 - off) & 0x3ffffff), p + 8);
7485 picfixup_size += 12;
7486
7487 /* Use one of the spare relocs, so --emit-relocs
7488 output is reasonable. */
7489 memmove (rel + 1, rel, (relend - rel - 1) * sizeof (*rel));
7490 wrel++, rel++;
7491 rel->r_offset = wrel[-1].r_offset + 4;
7492 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
7493 rel->r_addend = wrel[-1].r_addend;
7494
7495 /* Continue on as if we had a got reloc, to output
7496 dynamic reloc. */
7497 r_type = R_PPC_GOT16_LO;
7498 }
7499 else
7500 _bfd_error_handler
7501 /* xgettext:c-format */
7502 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7503 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7504 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7505 "R_PPC_ADDR16_HA", insn);
7506 }
7507 else if (r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16_LO)
7508 {
7509 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
7510 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
7511 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 14u << 26 /* addi */
7512 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 32u << 26 /* lwz */
7513 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 34u << 26 /* lbz */
7514 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 36u << 26 /* stw */
7515 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 38u << 26 /* stb */
7516 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 40u << 26 /* lhz */
7517 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 42u << 26 /* lha */
7518 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 44u << 26 /* sth */
7519 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 46u << 26 /* lmw */
7520 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 47u << 26 /* stmw */
7521 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 48u << 26 /* lfs */
7522 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 50u << 26 /* lfd */
7523 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 52u << 26 /* stfs */
7524 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 54u << 26 /* stfd */
7525 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 58u << 26 /* lwa,ld,lmd */
7526 && (insn & 3) != 1)
7527 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 62u << 26 /* std, stmd */
7528 && ((insn & 3) == 0 || (insn & 3) == 3)))
7529 {
7530 /* Arrange to apply the reloc addend, if any. */
7531 relocation = 0;
7532 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7533 rel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, r_type);
7534 }
7535 else
7536 _bfd_error_handler
7537 /* xgettext:c-format */
7538 (_("%pB(%pA+%#" PRIx64 "): error: "
7539 "%s with unexpected instruction %#x"),
7540 input_bfd, input_section, (uint64_t) rel->r_offset,
7541 "R_PPC_ADDR16_LO", insn);
7542 }
7543 }
7544
7545 ifunc = NULL;
7546 if (!htab->is_vxworks)
7547 {
7548 struct plt_entry *ent;
7549
7550 if (h != NULL)
7551 {
7552 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7553 ifunc = &h->plt.plist;
7554 }
7555 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL
7556 && ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
7557 {
7558 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
7559
7560 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
7561 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
7562 ifunc = local_plt + r_symndx;
7563 }
7564
7565 ent = NULL;
7566 if (ifunc != NULL
7567 && (!bfd_link_pic (info)
7568 || is_branch_reloc (r_type)
7569 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7570 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7571 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7572 {
7573 addend = 0;
7574 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7575 && (r_type == R_PPC_PLTREL24
7576 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_LO
7577 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HI
7578 || r_type == R_PPC_PLT16_HA))
7579 addend = rel->r_addend;
7580 ent = find_plt_ent (ifunc, got2, addend);
7581 }
7582 if (ent != NULL)
7583 {
7584 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
7585 && ent->sec != got2
7586 && htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW
7587 && (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7588 || h == NULL
7589 || h->dynindx == -1))
7590 {
7591 /* Uh oh, we are going to create a pic glink stub
7592 for an ifunc (here for h == NULL and later in
7593 finish_dynamic_symbol for h != NULL), and
7594 apparently are using code compiled with
7595 -mbss-plt. The difficulty is that -mbss-plt code
7596 gives no indication via a magic PLTREL24 addend
7597 whether r30 is equal to _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or
7598 is pointing into a .got2 section (and how far
7599 into .got2). */
7600 info->callbacks->einfo
7601 /* xgettext:c-format */
7602 (_("%X%H: unsupported bss-plt -fPIC ifunc %s\n"),
7603 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, sym_name);
7604 }
7605
7606 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7607 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
7608 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7609 || h == NULL
7610 || h->dynindx == -1)
7611 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
7612 + htab->glink->output_offset
7613 + (ent->glink_offset & ~1));
7614 else
7615 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
7616 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
7617 + ent->plt.offset);
7618 }
7619 }
7620
7621 addend = rel->r_addend;
7622 save_unresolved_reloc = unresolved_reloc;
7623 howto = NULL;
7624 if (r_type < R_PPC_max)
7625 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
7626
7627 switch (r_type)
7628 {
7629 default:
7630 break;
7631
7632 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
7633 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7634 {
7635 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7636 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7637 if ((insn & ((0x3f << 26) | 0x1f << 16))
7638 != ((15u << 26) | (2 << 16)) /* addis rt,2,imm */)
7639 /* xgettext:c-format */
7640 info->callbacks->minfo
7641 (_("%H: warning: %s unexpected insn %#x.\n"),
7642 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset, howto->name, insn);
7643 else
7644 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
7645 }
7646 break;
7647
7648 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
7649 if (htab->do_tls_opt && relocation + addend + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
7650 {
7651 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
7652 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
7653 insn &= ~(0x1f << 16);
7654 insn |= 2 << 16;
7655 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
7656 }
7657 break;
7658 }
7659
7660 tls_type = 0;
7661 switch (r_type)
7662 {
7663 default:
7664 /* xgettext:c-format */
7665 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
7666 input_bfd, howto->name);
7667
7668 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
7669 ret = FALSE;
7670 goto copy_reloc;
7671
7672 case R_PPC_NONE:
7673 case R_PPC_TLS:
7674 case R_PPC_TLSGD:
7675 case R_PPC_TLSLD:
7676 case R_PPC_EMB_MRKREF:
7677 case R_PPC_GNU_VTINHERIT:
7678 case R_PPC_GNU_VTENTRY:
7679 goto copy_reloc;
7680
7681 /* GOT16 relocations. Like an ADDR16 using the symbol's
7682 address in the GOT as relocation value instead of the
7683 symbol's value itself. Also, create a GOT entry for the
7684 symbol and put the symbol value there. */
7685 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
7686 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
7687 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HI:
7688 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
7689 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7690 goto dogot;
7691
7692 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
7693 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
7694 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HI:
7695 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
7696 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7697 goto dogot;
7698
7699 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
7700 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
7701 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HI:
7702 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
7703 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7704 goto dogot;
7705
7706 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
7707 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
7708 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HI:
7709 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
7710 tls_type = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7711 goto dogot;
7712
7713 case R_PPC_GOT16:
7714 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
7715 case R_PPC_GOT16_HI:
7716 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
7717 tls_mask = 0;
7718 dogot:
7719 {
7720 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the global
7721 offset table. */
7722 bfd_vma off;
7723 bfd_vma *offp;
7724 unsigned long indx;
7725
7726 if (htab->elf.sgot == NULL)
7727 abort ();
7728
7729 indx = 0;
7730 if (tls_type == (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD)
7731 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7732 offp = &htab->tlsld_got.offset;
7733 else if (h != NULL)
7734 {
7735 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
7736 || h->dynindx == -1
7737 || SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h)
7738 || UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7739 /* This is actually a static link, or it is a
7740 -Bsymbolic link and the symbol is defined
7741 locally, or the symbol was forced to be local
7742 because of a version file. */
7743 ;
7744 else
7745 {
7746 indx = h->dynindx;
7747 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
7748 }
7749 offp = &h->got.offset;
7750 }
7751 else
7752 {
7753 if (local_got_offsets == NULL)
7754 abort ();
7755 offp = &local_got_offsets[r_symndx];
7756 }
7757
7758 /* The offset must always be a multiple of 4. We use the
7759 least significant bit to record whether we have already
7760 processed this entry. */
7761 off = *offp;
7762 if ((off & 1) != 0)
7763 off &= ~1;
7764 else
7765 {
7766 unsigned int tls_m = ((tls_mask & TLS_TLS) != 0
7767 ? tls_mask & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL
7768 | TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)
7769 : 0);
7770
7771 if (offp == &htab->tlsld_got.offset)
7772 tls_m = TLS_LD;
7773 else if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0
7774 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7775 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7776
7777 /* We might have multiple got entries for this sym.
7778 Initialize them all. */
7779 do
7780 {
7781 int tls_ty = 0;
7782
7783 if ((tls_m & TLS_LD) != 0)
7784 {
7785 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_LD;
7786 tls_m &= ~TLS_LD;
7787 }
7788 else if ((tls_m & TLS_GD) != 0)
7789 {
7790 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_GD;
7791 tls_m &= ~TLS_GD;
7792 }
7793 else if ((tls_m & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7794 {
7795 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL;
7796 tls_m &= ~TLS_DTPREL;
7797 }
7798 else if ((tls_m & (TLS_TPREL | TLS_GDIE)) != 0)
7799 {
7800 tls_ty = TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL;
7801 tls_m = 0;
7802 }
7803
7804 /* Generate relocs for the dynamic linker. */
7805 if (indx != 0
7806 || (bfd_link_pic (info)
7807 && (h == NULL
7808 || !UNDEFWEAK_NO_DYNAMIC_RELOC (info, h))
7809 && !(tls_ty != 0
7810 && bfd_link_executable (info)
7811 && SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))))
7812 {
7813 asection *rsec = htab->elf.srelgot;
7814 bfd_byte * loc;
7815
7816 if (ifunc != NULL)
7817 {
7818 rsec = htab->elf.irelplt;
7819 if (indx == 0)
7820 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7821 else if (is_static_defined (h))
7822 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
7823 }
7824 outrel.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7825 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7826 + off);
7827 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7828 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7829 {
7830 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPMOD32);
7831 if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7832 {
7833 loc = rsec->contents;
7834 loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7835 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7836 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd,
7837 &outrel, loc);
7838 outrel.r_offset += 4;
7839 outrel.r_info
7840 = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7841 }
7842 }
7843 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7844 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_DTPREL32);
7845 else if (tls_ty == (TLS_TLS | TLS_TPREL))
7846 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_TPREL32);
7847 else if (indx != 0)
7848 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, R_PPC_GLOB_DAT);
7849 else if (ifunc != NULL)
7850 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
7851 else
7852 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
7853 if (indx == 0 && tls_ty != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7854 {
7855 outrel.r_addend += relocation;
7856 if (tls_ty & (TLS_GD | TLS_DTPREL | TLS_TPREL))
7857 {
7858 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7859 outrel.r_addend = 0;
7860 else
7861 outrel.r_addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma;
7862 }
7863 }
7864 loc = rsec->contents;
7865 loc += (rsec->reloc_count++
7866 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
7867 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
7868 }
7869
7870 /* Init the .got section contents if we're not
7871 emitting a reloc. */
7872 else
7873 {
7874 bfd_vma value = relocation;
7875
7876 if (tls_ty != 0)
7877 {
7878 if (htab->elf.tls_sec == NULL)
7879 value = 0;
7880 else
7881 {
7882 if (tls_ty & TLS_LD)
7883 value = 0;
7884 else
7885 value -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7886 if (tls_ty & TLS_TPREL)
7887 value += DTP_OFFSET - TP_OFFSET;
7888 }
7889
7890 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7891 {
7892 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7893 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off + 4);
7894 value = 1;
7895 }
7896 }
7897 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, value,
7898 htab->elf.sgot->contents + off);
7899 }
7900
7901 off += 4;
7902 if (tls_ty & (TLS_LD | TLS_GD))
7903 off += 4;
7904 }
7905 while (tls_m != 0);
7906
7907 off = *offp;
7908 *offp = off | 1;
7909 }
7910
7911 if (off >= (bfd_vma) -2)
7912 abort ();
7913
7914 if ((tls_type & TLS_TLS) != 0)
7915 {
7916 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_LD))
7917 {
7918 if ((tls_mask & TLS_LD) != 0
7919 && !SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
7920 off += 8;
7921 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_GD))
7922 {
7923 if ((tls_mask & TLS_GD) != 0)
7924 off += 8;
7925 if (tls_type != (TLS_TLS | TLS_DTPREL))
7926 {
7927 if ((tls_mask & TLS_DTPREL) != 0)
7928 off += 4;
7929 }
7930 }
7931 }
7932 }
7933
7934 /* If here for a picfixup, we're done. */
7935 if (r_type != ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
7936 goto copy_reloc;
7937
7938 relocation = (htab->elf.sgot->output_section->vma
7939 + htab->elf.sgot->output_offset
7940 + off
7941 - SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot));
7942
7943 /* Addends on got relocations don't make much sense.
7944 x+off@got is actually x@got+off, and since the got is
7945 generated by a hash table traversal, the value in the
7946 got at entry m+n bears little relation to the entry m. */
7947 if (addend != 0)
7948 info->callbacks->einfo
7949 /* xgettext:c-format */
7950 (_("%H: non-zero addend on %s reloc against `%s'\n"),
7951 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7952 howto->name,
7953 sym_name);
7954 }
7955 break;
7956
7957 /* Relocations that need no special processing. */
7958 case R_PPC_LOCAL24PC:
7959 /* It makes no sense to point a local relocation
7960 at a symbol not in this object. */
7961 if (unresolved_reloc)
7962 {
7963 (*info->callbacks->undefined_symbol) (info,
7964 h->root.root.string,
7965 input_bfd,
7966 input_section,
7967 rel->r_offset,
7968 TRUE);
7969 goto copy_reloc;
7970 }
7971 if (h != NULL && h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && bfd_link_pic (info))
7972 {
7973 /* @local on an ifunc does not really make sense since
7974 the ifunc resolver can take you anywhere. More
7975 seriously, calls to ifuncs must go through a plt call
7976 stub, and for pic the plt call stubs uses r30 to
7977 access the PLT. The problem is that a call that is
7978 local won't have the +32k reloc addend trick marking
7979 -fPIC code, so the linker won't know whether r30 is
7980 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_ or pointing into a .got2 section. */
7981 /* xgettext:c-format */
7982 info->callbacks->einfo (_("%X%H: @local call to ifunc %s\n"),
7983 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
7984 h->root.root.string);
7985 }
7986 break;
7987
7988 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
7989 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
7990 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HI:
7991 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
7992 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
7993 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
7994 break;
7995
7996 /* Relocations that may need to be propagated if this is a shared
7997 object. */
7998 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
7999 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8000 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HI:
8001 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8002 if (h != NULL
8003 && h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
8004 && h->dynindx == -1)
8005 {
8006 /* Make this relocation against an undefined weak symbol
8007 resolve to zero. This is really just a tweak, since
8008 code using weak externs ought to check that they are
8009 defined before using them. */
8010 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset;
8011 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8012 insn = _bfd_elf_ppc_at_tprel_transform (insn, 2);
8013 if (insn != 0)
8014 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, p);
8015 break;
8016 }
8017 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8018 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8019 /* The TPREL16 relocs shouldn't really be used in shared
8020 libs or with non-local symbols as that will result in
8021 DT_TEXTREL being set, but support them anyway. */
8022 goto dodyn;
8023
8024 case R_PPC_TPREL32:
8025 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8026 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + TP_OFFSET;
8027 goto dodyn;
8028
8029 case R_PPC_DTPREL32:
8030 if (htab->elf.tls_sec != NULL)
8031 addend -= htab->elf.tls_sec->vma + DTP_OFFSET;
8032 goto dodyn;
8033
8034 case R_PPC_DTPMOD32:
8035 relocation = 1;
8036 addend = 0;
8037 goto dodyn;
8038
8039 case R_PPC_REL16:
8040 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
8041 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
8042 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8043 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8044 break;
8045
8046 case R_PPC_REL32:
8047 if (h == NULL || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8048 break;
8049 /* fall through */
8050
8051 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
8052 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8053 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8054 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HI:
8055 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8056 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
8057 case R_PPC_UADDR16:
8058 goto dodyn;
8059
8060 case R_PPC_VLE_REL8:
8061 case R_PPC_VLE_REL15:
8062 case R_PPC_VLE_REL24:
8063 case R_PPC_REL24:
8064 case R_PPC_REL14:
8065 case R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN:
8066 case R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN:
8067 /* If these relocations are not to a named symbol, they can be
8068 handled right here, no need to bother the dynamic linker. */
8069 if (SYMBOL_CALLS_LOCAL (info, h)
8070 || h == htab->elf.hgot)
8071 break;
8072 /* fall through */
8073
8074 case R_PPC_ADDR24:
8075 case R_PPC_ADDR14:
8076 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRTAKEN:
8077 case R_PPC_ADDR14_BRNTAKEN:
8078 if (h != NULL && !bfd_link_pic (info))
8079 break;
8080 /* fall through */
8081
8082 dodyn:
8083 if ((input_section->flags & SEC_ALLOC) == 0
8084 || is_vxworks_tls)
8085 break;
8086
8087 if (bfd_link_pic (info)
8088 ? ((h == NULL
8089 || ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL)
8090 && ((h != NULL && pc_dynrelocs (h))
8091 || must_be_dyn_reloc (info, r_type)))
8092 : (h != NULL
8093 && ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->dyn_relocs != NULL))
8094 {
8095 int skip;
8096 bfd_byte *loc;
8097 asection *sreloc;
8098 long indx = 0;
8099
8100 #ifdef DEBUG
8101 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_relocate_section needs to "
8102 "create relocation for %s\n",
8103 (h && h->root.root.string
8104 ? h->root.root.string : "<unknown>"));
8105 #endif
8106
8107 /* When generating a shared object, these relocations
8108 are copied into the output file to be resolved at run
8109 time. */
8110 skip = 0;
8111 outrel.r_offset = _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info,
8112 input_section,
8113 rel->r_offset);
8114 if (outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -1
8115 || outrel.r_offset == (bfd_vma) -2)
8116 skip = (int) outrel.r_offset;
8117 outrel.r_offset += (input_section->output_section->vma
8118 + input_section->output_offset);
8119
8120 /* Optimize unaligned reloc use. */
8121 if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) != 0)
8122 || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR32 && (outrel.r_offset & 3) == 0))
8123 r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR32 ^ R_PPC_UADDR32;
8124 if ((r_type == R_PPC_ADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) != 0)
8125 || (r_type == R_PPC_UADDR16 && (outrel.r_offset & 1) == 0))
8126 r_type ^= R_PPC_ADDR16 ^ R_PPC_UADDR16;
8127
8128 if (skip)
8129 memset (&outrel, 0, sizeof outrel);
8130 else if (!SYMBOL_REFERENCES_LOCAL (info, h))
8131 {
8132 indx = h->dynindx;
8133 BFD_ASSERT (indx != -1);
8134 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8135 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8136 outrel.r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8137 }
8138 else
8139 {
8140 outrel.r_addend = relocation + rel->r_addend;
8141
8142 if (r_type != R_PPC_ADDR32)
8143 {
8144 if (ifunc != NULL)
8145 {
8146 /* If we get here when building a static
8147 executable, then the libc startup function
8148 responsible for applying indirect function
8149 relocations is going to complain about
8150 the reloc type.
8151 If we get here when building a dynamic
8152 executable, it will be because we have
8153 a text relocation. The dynamic loader
8154 will set the text segment writable and
8155 non-executable to apply text relocations.
8156 So we'll segfault when trying to run the
8157 indirection function to resolve the reloc. */
8158 info->callbacks->einfo
8159 /* xgettext:c-format */
8160 (_("%H: relocation %s for indirect "
8161 "function %s unsupported\n"),
8162 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8163 howto->name,
8164 sym_name);
8165 ret = FALSE;
8166 }
8167 else if (r_symndx == STN_UNDEF || bfd_is_abs_section (sec))
8168 ;
8169 else if (sec == NULL || sec->owner == NULL)
8170 {
8171 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8172 ret = FALSE;
8173 }
8174 else
8175 {
8176 asection *osec;
8177
8178 /* We are turning this relocation into one
8179 against a section symbol. It would be
8180 proper to subtract the symbol's value,
8181 osec->vma, from the emitted reloc addend,
8182 but ld.so expects buggy relocs.
8183 FIXME: Why not always use a zero index? */
8184 osec = sec->output_section;
8185 if ((osec->flags & SEC_THREAD_LOCAL) != 0)
8186 {
8187 osec = htab->elf.tls_sec;
8188 indx = 0;
8189 }
8190 else
8191 {
8192 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8193 if (indx == 0)
8194 {
8195 osec = htab->elf.text_index_section;
8196 indx = elf_section_data (osec)->dynindx;
8197 }
8198 BFD_ASSERT (indx != 0);
8199 }
8200
8201 /* ld.so doesn't expect buggy TLS relocs.
8202 Don't leave the symbol value in the
8203 addend for them. */
8204 if (IS_PPC_TLS_RELOC (r_type))
8205 outrel.r_addend -= osec->vma;
8206 }
8207
8208 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (indx, r_type);
8209 }
8210 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8211 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
8212 else
8213 outrel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
8214 }
8215
8216 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
8217 if (ifunc)
8218 {
8219 sreloc = htab->elf.irelplt;
8220 if (indx == 0)
8221 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8222 else if (is_static_defined (h))
8223 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
8224 }
8225 if (sreloc == NULL)
8226 return FALSE;
8227
8228 loc = sreloc->contents;
8229 loc += sreloc->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
8230 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel, loc);
8231
8232 if (skip == -1)
8233 goto copy_reloc;
8234
8235 /* This reloc will be computed at runtime. Clear the memory
8236 so that it contains a predictable value for prelink. */
8237 if (!skip)
8238 {
8239 relocation = howto->pc_relative ? outrel.r_offset : 0;
8240 addend = 0;
8241 break;
8242 }
8243 }
8244 break;
8245
8246 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLT:
8247 case R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24:
8248 if (h != NULL)
8249 {
8250 struct plt_entry *ent;
8251 bfd_vma got2_addend = 0;
8252
8253 if (r_type == R_PPC_RELAX_PLTREL24)
8254 {
8255 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8256 got2_addend = addend;
8257 addend = 0;
8258 }
8259 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2, got2_addend);
8260 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8261 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8262 + htab->glink->output_offset
8263 + ent->glink_offset);
8264 else
8265 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8266 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8267 + ent->plt.offset);
8268 }
8269 /* Fall through. */
8270
8271 case R_PPC_RELAX:
8272 {
8273 const int *stub;
8274 size_t size;
8275 size_t insn_offset = rel->r_offset;
8276 unsigned int insn;
8277
8278 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8279 {
8280 relocation -= (input_section->output_section->vma
8281 + input_section->output_offset
8282 + rel->r_offset - 4);
8283 stub = shared_stub_entry;
8284 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[0], contents + insn_offset - 12);
8285 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[1], contents + insn_offset - 8);
8286 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, stub[2], contents + insn_offset - 4);
8287 stub += 3;
8288 size = ARRAY_SIZE (shared_stub_entry) - 3;
8289 }
8290 else
8291 {
8292 stub = stub_entry;
8293 size = ARRAY_SIZE (stub_entry);
8294 }
8295
8296 relocation += addend;
8297 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info))
8298 relocation = 0;
8299
8300 /* First insn is HA, second is LO. */
8301 insn = *stub++;
8302 insn |= ((relocation + 0x8000) >> 16) & 0xffff;
8303 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8304 insn_offset += 4;
8305
8306 insn = *stub++;
8307 insn |= relocation & 0xffff;
8308 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8309 insn_offset += 4;
8310 size -= 2;
8311
8312 while (size != 0)
8313 {
8314 insn = *stub++;
8315 --size;
8316 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + insn_offset);
8317 insn_offset += 4;
8318 }
8319
8320 /* Rewrite the reloc and convert one of the trailing nop
8321 relocs to describe this relocation. */
8322 BFD_ASSERT (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info) == R_PPC_NONE);
8323 /* The relocs are at the bottom 2 bytes */
8324 wrel->r_offset = rel->r_offset + d_offset;
8325 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
8326 wrel->r_addend = rel->r_addend;
8327 memmove (wrel + 1, wrel, (relend - wrel - 1) * sizeof (*wrel));
8328 wrel++, rel++;
8329 wrel->r_offset += 4;
8330 wrel->r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_symndx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
8331 }
8332 continue;
8333
8334 /* Indirect .sdata relocation. */
8335 case R_PPC_EMB_SDAI16:
8336 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[0].section != NULL);
8337 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[0].sym))
8338 {
8339 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8340 break;
8341 }
8342 relocation
8343 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[0],
8344 h, relocation, rel);
8345 addend = 0;
8346 break;
8347
8348 /* Indirect .sdata2 relocation. */
8349 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2I16:
8350 BFD_ASSERT (htab->sdata[1].section != NULL);
8351 if (!is_static_defined (htab->sdata[1].sym))
8352 {
8353 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8354 break;
8355 }
8356 relocation
8357 = elf_finish_pointer_linker_section (input_bfd, &htab->sdata[1],
8358 h, relocation, rel);
8359 addend = 0;
8360 break;
8361
8362 /* Handle the TOC16 reloc. We want to use the offset within the .got
8363 section, not the actual VMA. This is appropriate when generating
8364 an embedded ELF object, for which the .got section acts like the
8365 AIX .toc section. */
8366 case R_PPC_TOC16: /* phony GOT16 relocations */
8367 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8368 {
8369 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8370 break;
8371 }
8372 BFD_ASSERT (strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".got") == 0
8373 || strcmp (bfd_section_name (sec), ".cgot") == 0);
8374
8375 addend -= sec->output_section->vma + sec->output_offset + 0x8000;
8376 break;
8377
8378 case R_PPC_PLTREL24:
8379 if (h != NULL && ifunc == NULL)
8380 {
8381 struct plt_entry *ent;
8382
8383 ent = find_plt_ent (&h->plt.plist, got2,
8384 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8385 if (ent == NULL
8386 || htab->elf.splt == NULL)
8387 {
8388 /* We didn't make a PLT entry for this symbol. This
8389 happens when statically linking PIC code, or when
8390 using -Bsymbolic. */
8391 }
8392 else
8393 {
8394 /* Relocation is to the entry for this symbol in the
8395 procedure linkage table. */
8396 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8397 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW)
8398 relocation = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
8399 + htab->glink->output_offset
8400 + ent->glink_offset);
8401 else
8402 relocation = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
8403 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
8404 + ent->plt.offset);
8405 }
8406 }
8407
8408 /* R_PPC_PLTREL24 is rather special. If non-zero, the
8409 addend specifies the GOT pointer offset within .got2.
8410 Don't apply it to the relocation field. */
8411 addend = 0;
8412 break;
8413
8414 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8415 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8416 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8417 case R_PPC_PLT16_HI:
8418 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8419 plt_list = NULL;
8420 if (h != NULL)
8421 plt_list = &h->plt.plist;
8422 else if (ifunc != NULL)
8423 plt_list = ifunc;
8424 else if (local_got_offsets != NULL)
8425 {
8426 struct plt_entry **local_plt;
8427 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) (local_got_offsets
8428 + symtab_hdr->sh_info);
8429 plt_list = local_plt + r_symndx;
8430 }
8431 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8432 if (plt_list != NULL)
8433 {
8434 struct plt_entry *ent;
8435
8436 ent = find_plt_ent (plt_list, got2,
8437 bfd_link_pic (info) ? addend : 0);
8438 if (ent != NULL && ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
8439 {
8440 asection *plt;
8441
8442 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8443 plt = htab->elf.splt;
8444 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
8445 || h == NULL
8446 || h->dynindx == -1)
8447 {
8448 if (ifunc != NULL)
8449 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
8450 else
8451 plt = htab->pltlocal;
8452 }
8453 relocation = (plt->output_section->vma
8454 + plt->output_offset
8455 + ent->plt.offset);
8456 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
8457 {
8458 bfd_vma got = 0;
8459
8460 if (ent->addend >= 32768)
8461 got = (ent->addend
8462 + ent->sec->output_section->vma
8463 + ent->sec->output_offset);
8464 else
8465 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
8466 relocation -= got;
8467 }
8468 }
8469 }
8470 addend = 0;
8471 break;
8472
8473 /* Relocate against _SDA_BASE_. */
8474 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8475 {
8476 const char *name;
8477 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8478
8479 if (sec == NULL
8480 || sec->output_section == NULL
8481 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8482 {
8483 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8484 break;
8485 }
8486 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8487
8488 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8489 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8490 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0))
8491 {
8492 _bfd_error_handler
8493 /* xgettext:c-format */
8494 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8495 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8496 input_bfd,
8497 sym_name,
8498 howto->name,
8499 name);
8500 }
8501 }
8502 break;
8503
8504 /* Relocate against _SDA2_BASE_. */
8505 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA2REL:
8506 {
8507 const char *name;
8508 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8509
8510 if (sec == NULL
8511 || sec->output_section == NULL
8512 || !is_static_defined (sda))
8513 {
8514 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8515 break;
8516 }
8517 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8518
8519 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8520 if (!(strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8521 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0))
8522 {
8523 _bfd_error_handler
8524 /* xgettext:c-format */
8525 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8526 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8527 input_bfd,
8528 sym_name,
8529 howto->name,
8530 name);
8531 }
8532 }
8533 break;
8534
8535 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16A:
8536 relocation = relocation + addend;
8537 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8538 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8539 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8540 goto copy_reloc;
8541
8542 case R_PPC_VLE_LO16D:
8543 relocation = relocation + addend;
8544 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8545 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8546 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8547 goto copy_reloc;
8548
8549 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16A:
8550 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8551 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8552 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8553 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8554 goto copy_reloc;
8555
8556 case R_PPC_VLE_HI16D:
8557 relocation = (relocation + addend) >> 16;
8558 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8559 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8560 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8561 goto copy_reloc;
8562
8563 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16A:
8564 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8565 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8566 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8567 split16a_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8568 goto copy_reloc;
8569
8570 case R_PPC_VLE_HA16D:
8571 relocation = (relocation + addend + 0x8000) >> 16;
8572 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8573 contents + rel->r_offset, relocation,
8574 split16d_type, htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8575 goto copy_reloc;
8576
8577 /* Relocate against either _SDA_BASE_, _SDA2_BASE_, or 0. */
8578 case R_PPC_EMB_SDA21:
8579 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21:
8580 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA:
8581 case R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO:
8582 {
8583 const char *name;
8584 int reg;
8585 unsigned int insn;
8586 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8587
8588 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8589 {
8590 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8591 break;
8592 }
8593
8594 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8595 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8596 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8597 {
8598 reg = 13;
8599 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8600 }
8601 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8602 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8603 {
8604 reg = 2;
8605 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8606 }
8607 else if (strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sdata0") == 0
8608 || strcmp (name, ".PPC.EMB.sbss0") == 0)
8609 {
8610 reg = 0;
8611 }
8612 else
8613 {
8614 _bfd_error_handler
8615 /* xgettext:c-format */
8616 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8617 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8618 input_bfd,
8619 sym_name,
8620 howto->name,
8621 name);
8622
8623 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8624 ret = FALSE;
8625 goto copy_reloc;
8626 }
8627
8628 if (sda != NULL)
8629 {
8630 if (!is_static_defined (sda))
8631 {
8632 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8633 break;
8634 }
8635 addend -= SYM_VAL (sda);
8636 }
8637
8638 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_RELSDA)
8639 break;
8640
8641 /* The PowerPC Embedded Application Binary Interface
8642 version 1.0 insanely chose to specify R_PPC_EMB_SDA21
8643 operating on a 24-bit field at r_offset. GNU as and
8644 GNU ld have always assumed R_PPC_EMB_SDA21 operates on
8645 a 32-bit bit insn at r_offset. Cope with object file
8646 producers that possibly comply with the EABI in
8647 generating an odd r_offset for big-endian objects. */
8648 if (r_type == R_PPC_EMB_SDA21)
8649 rel->r_offset &= ~1;
8650
8651 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
8652 if (reg == 0
8653 && (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8654 || r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21_LO))
8655 {
8656 relocation = relocation + addend;
8657 addend = 0;
8658
8659 /* Force e_li insn, keeping RT from original insn. */
8660 insn &= 0x1f << 21;
8661 insn |= 28u << 26;
8662
8663 /* We have an li20 field, bits 17..20, 11..15, 21..31. */
8664 /* Top 4 bits of value to 17..20. */
8665 insn |= (relocation & 0xf0000) >> 5;
8666 /* Next 5 bits of the value to 11..15. */
8667 insn |= (relocation & 0xf800) << 5;
8668 /* And the final 11 bits of the value to bits 21 to 31. */
8669 insn |= relocation & 0x7ff;
8670
8671 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8672
8673 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDA21
8674 && ((relocation + 0x80000) & 0xffffffff) > 0x100000)
8675 goto overflow;
8676 goto copy_reloc;
8677 }
8678 /* Fill in register field. */
8679 insn = (insn & ~RA_REGISTER_MASK) | (reg << RA_REGISTER_SHIFT);
8680 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
8681 }
8682 break;
8683
8684 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A:
8685 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D:
8686 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A:
8687 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D:
8688 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A:
8689 case R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D:
8690 {
8691 bfd_vma value;
8692 const char *name;
8693 struct elf_link_hash_entry *sda = NULL;
8694
8695 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8696 {
8697 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8698 break;
8699 }
8700
8701 name = bfd_section_name (sec->output_section);
8702 if (strcmp (name, ".sdata") == 0
8703 || strcmp (name, ".sbss") == 0)
8704 sda = htab->sdata[0].sym;
8705 else if (strcmp (name, ".sdata2") == 0
8706 || strcmp (name, ".sbss2") == 0)
8707 sda = htab->sdata[1].sym;
8708 else
8709 {
8710 _bfd_error_handler
8711 /* xgettext:c-format */
8712 (_("%pB: the target (%s) of a %s relocation is "
8713 "in the wrong output section (%s)"),
8714 input_bfd,
8715 sym_name,
8716 howto->name,
8717 name);
8718
8719 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8720 ret = FALSE;
8721 goto copy_reloc;
8722 }
8723
8724 if (sda == NULL || !is_static_defined (sda))
8725 {
8726 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8727 break;
8728 }
8729 value = relocation + addend - SYM_VAL (sda);
8730
8731 if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16A)
8732 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8733 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8734 split16a_type,
8735 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8736 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_LO16D)
8737 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8738 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8739 split16d_type,
8740 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8741 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16A)
8742 {
8743 value = value >> 16;
8744 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8745 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8746 split16a_type,
8747 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8748 }
8749 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HI16D)
8750 {
8751 value = value >> 16;
8752 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8753 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8754 split16d_type,
8755 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8756 }
8757 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16A)
8758 {
8759 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8760 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8761 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8762 split16a_type,
8763 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8764 }
8765 else if (r_type == R_PPC_VLE_SDAREL_HA16D)
8766 {
8767 value = (value + 0x8000) >> 16;
8768 ppc_elf_vle_split16 (input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8769 contents + rel->r_offset, value,
8770 split16d_type,
8771 htab->params->vle_reloc_fixup);
8772 }
8773 }
8774 goto copy_reloc;
8775
8776 case R_PPC_VLE_ADDR20:
8777 ppc_elf_vle_split20 (output_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset, relocation);
8778 continue;
8779
8780 /* Relocate against the beginning of the section. */
8781 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8782 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8783 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HI:
8784 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8785 if (sec == NULL || sec->output_section == NULL)
8786 {
8787 unresolved_reloc = TRUE;
8788 break;
8789 }
8790 addend -= sec->output_section->vma;
8791 break;
8792
8793 /* Negative relocations. */
8794 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR32:
8795 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16:
8796 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_LO:
8797 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HI:
8798 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8799 addend -= 2 * relocation;
8800 break;
8801
8802 case R_PPC_COPY:
8803 case R_PPC_GLOB_DAT:
8804 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
8805 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
8806 case R_PPC_IRELATIVE:
8807 case R_PPC_PLT32:
8808 case R_PPC_PLTREL32:
8809 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
8810 case R_PPC_EMB_RELSEC16:
8811 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_LO:
8812 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HI:
8813 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8814 case R_PPC_EMB_BIT_FLD:
8815 /* xgettext:c-format */
8816 _bfd_error_handler (_("%pB: %s unsupported"),
8817 input_bfd, howto->name);
8818
8819 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_invalid_operation);
8820 ret = FALSE;
8821 goto copy_reloc;
8822 }
8823
8824 switch (r_type)
8825 {
8826 default:
8827 break;
8828
8829 case R_PPC_PLTCALL:
8830 if (unresolved_reloc)
8831 {
8832 bfd_byte *p = contents + rel->r_offset;
8833 unsigned int insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, p);
8834 insn &= 1;
8835 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B | insn, p);
8836 unresolved_reloc = save_unresolved_reloc;
8837 r_type = R_PPC_REL24;
8838 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8839 }
8840 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8841 info->callbacks->einfo
8842 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8843 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8844 howto->name);
8845 break;
8846
8847 case R_PPC_PLTSEQ:
8848 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8849 case R_PPC_PLT16_LO:
8850 if (unresolved_reloc)
8851 {
8852 bfd_byte *p = contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3);
8853 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, NOP, p);
8854 unresolved_reloc = FALSE;
8855 r_type = R_PPC_NONE;
8856 howto = ppc_elf_howto_table[r_type];
8857 }
8858 else if (htab->plt_type != PLT_NEW)
8859 info->callbacks->einfo
8860 (_("%X%P: %H: %s relocation unsupported for bss-plt\n"),
8861 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8862 howto->name);
8863 break;
8864 }
8865
8866 /* Do any further special processing. */
8867 switch (r_type)
8868 {
8869 default:
8870 break;
8871
8872 case R_PPC_ADDR16_HA:
8873 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
8874 case R_PPC_REL16DX_HA:
8875 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_HA:
8876 case R_PPC_TPREL16_HA:
8877 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_HA:
8878 case R_PPC_EMB_NADDR16_HA:
8879 case R_PPC_EMB_RELST_HA:
8880 /* It's just possible that this symbol is a weak symbol
8881 that's not actually defined anywhere. In that case,
8882 'sec' would be NULL, and we should leave the symbol
8883 alone (it will be set to zero elsewhere in the link). */
8884 if (sec == NULL)
8885 break;
8886 /* Fall through. */
8887
8888 case R_PPC_PLT16_HA:
8889 case R_PPC_GOT16_HA:
8890 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_HA:
8891 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_HA:
8892 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_HA:
8893 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_HA:
8894 /* Add 0x10000 if sign bit in 0:15 is set.
8895 Bits 0:15 are not used. */
8896 addend += 0x8000;
8897 break;
8898
8899 case R_PPC_ADDR16:
8900 case R_PPC_ADDR16_LO:
8901 case R_PPC_GOT16:
8902 case R_PPC_GOT16_LO:
8903 case R_PPC_SDAREL16:
8904 case R_PPC_SECTOFF:
8905 case R_PPC_SECTOFF_LO:
8906 case R_PPC_DTPREL16:
8907 case R_PPC_DTPREL16_LO:
8908 case R_PPC_TPREL16:
8909 case R_PPC_TPREL16_LO:
8910 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16:
8911 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSGD16_LO:
8912 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16:
8913 case R_PPC_GOT_TLSLD16_LO:
8914 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16:
8915 case R_PPC_GOT_DTPREL16_LO:
8916 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16:
8917 case R_PPC_GOT_TPREL16_LO:
8918 {
8919 /* The 32-bit ABI lacks proper relocations to deal with
8920 certain 64-bit instructions. Prevent damage to bits
8921 that make up part of the insn opcode. */
8922 unsigned int insn, mask, lobit;
8923
8924 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd,
8925 contents + rel->r_offset - d_offset);
8926 mask = 0;
8927 if (is_insn_ds_form (insn))
8928 mask = 3;
8929 else if (is_insn_dq_form (insn))
8930 mask = 15;
8931 else
8932 break;
8933 relocation += addend;
8934 addend = insn & mask;
8935 lobit = mask & relocation;
8936 if (lobit != 0)
8937 {
8938 relocation ^= lobit;
8939 info->callbacks->einfo
8940 /* xgettext:c-format */
8941 (_("%H: error: %s against `%s' not a multiple of %u\n"),
8942 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8943 howto->name, sym_name, mask + 1);
8944 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
8945 ret = FALSE;
8946 }
8947 }
8948 break;
8949 }
8950
8951 #ifdef DEBUG
8952 fprintf (stderr, "\ttype = %s (%d), name = %s, symbol index = %ld, "
8953 "offset = %ld, addend = %ld\n",
8954 howto->name,
8955 (int) r_type,
8956 sym_name,
8957 r_symndx,
8958 (long) rel->r_offset,
8959 (long) addend);
8960 #endif
8961
8962 if (unresolved_reloc
8963 && !((input_section->flags & SEC_DEBUGGING) != 0
8964 && h->def_dynamic)
8965 && _bfd_elf_section_offset (output_bfd, info, input_section,
8966 rel->r_offset) != (bfd_vma) -1)
8967 {
8968 info->callbacks->einfo
8969 /* xgettext:c-format */
8970 (_("%H: unresolvable %s relocation against symbol `%s'\n"),
8971 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
8972 howto->name,
8973 sym_name);
8974 ret = FALSE;
8975 }
8976
8977 /* 16-bit fields in insns mostly have signed values, but a
8978 few insns have 16-bit unsigned values. Really, we should
8979 have different reloc types. */
8980 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain_overflow_dont
8981 && howto->dst_mask == 0xffff
8982 && (input_section->flags & SEC_CODE) != 0)
8983 {
8984 enum complain_overflow complain = complain_overflow_signed;
8985
8986 if ((elf_section_flags (input_section) & SHF_PPC_VLE) == 0)
8987 {
8988 unsigned int insn;
8989
8990 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + (rel->r_offset & ~3));
8991 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 10u << 26 /* cmpli */)
8992 complain = complain_overflow_bitfield;
8993 else if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 28u << 26 /* andi */
8994 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 24u << 26 /* ori */
8995 || (insn & (0x3f << 26)) == 26u << 26 /* xori */)
8996 complain = complain_overflow_unsigned;
8997 }
8998 if (howto->complain_on_overflow != complain)
8999 {
9000 alt_howto = *howto;
9001 alt_howto.complain_on_overflow = complain;
9002 howto = &alt_howto;
9003 }
9004 }
9005
9006 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL16DX_HA)
9007 {
9008 /* Split field reloc isn't handled by _bfd_final_link_relocate. */
9009 if (rel->r_offset + 4 > input_section->size)
9010 r = bfd_reloc_outofrange;
9011 else
9012 {
9013 unsigned int insn;
9014
9015 relocation += addend;
9016 relocation -= (rel->r_offset
9017 + input_section->output_offset
9018 + input_section->output_section->vma);
9019 relocation >>= 16;
9020 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + rel->r_offset);
9021 insn &= ~0x1fffc1;
9022 insn |= (relocation & 0xffc1) | ((relocation & 0x3e) << 15);
9023 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + rel->r_offset);
9024 r = bfd_reloc_ok;
9025 }
9026 }
9027 else
9028 r = _bfd_final_link_relocate (howto, input_bfd, input_section, contents,
9029 rel->r_offset, relocation, addend);
9030
9031 if (r != bfd_reloc_ok)
9032 {
9033 if (r == bfd_reloc_overflow)
9034 {
9035 overflow:
9036 /* On code like "if (foo) foo();" don't report overflow
9037 on a branch to zero when foo is undefined. */
9038 if (!warned
9039 && !(h != NULL
9040 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefweak
9041 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_undefined)
9042 && is_branch_reloc (r_type)))
9043 info->callbacks->reloc_overflow
9044 (info, (h ? &h->root : NULL), sym_name, howto->name,
9045 rel->r_addend, input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset);
9046 }
9047 else
9048 {
9049 info->callbacks->einfo
9050 /* xgettext:c-format */
9051 (_("%H: %s reloc against `%s': error %d\n"),
9052 input_bfd, input_section, rel->r_offset,
9053 howto->name, sym_name, (int) r);
9054 ret = FALSE;
9055 }
9056 }
9057 copy_reloc:
9058 if (wrel != rel)
9059 *wrel = *rel;
9060 }
9061
9062 if (wrel != rel)
9063 {
9064 Elf_Internal_Shdr *rel_hdr;
9065 size_t deleted = rel - wrel;
9066
9067 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section->output_section);
9068 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9069 if (rel_hdr->sh_size == 0)
9070 {
9071 /* It is too late to remove an empty reloc section. Leave
9072 one NONE reloc.
9073 ??? What is wrong with an empty section??? */
9074 rel_hdr->sh_size = rel_hdr->sh_entsize;
9075 deleted -= 1;
9076 wrel++;
9077 }
9078 relend = wrel;
9079 rel_hdr = _bfd_elf_single_rel_hdr (input_section);
9080 rel_hdr->sh_size -= rel_hdr->sh_entsize * deleted;
9081 input_section->reloc_count -= deleted;
9082 }
9083
9084 #ifdef DEBUG
9085 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9086 #endif
9087
9088 if (input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9089 && input_section->size != input_section->rawsize
9090 && (strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".init") == 0
9091 || strcmp (input_section->output_section->name, ".fini") == 0))
9092 {
9093 /* Branch around the trampolines. */
9094 unsigned int insn = B + input_section->size - input_section->rawsize;
9095 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + input_section->rawsize);
9096 }
9097
9098 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround
9099 && input_section->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_TARGET
9100 && (!bfd_link_relocatable (info)
9101 || (input_section->output_section->alignment_power
9102 >= htab->params->pagesize_p2)))
9103 {
9104 bfd_vma start_addr, end_addr, addr;
9105 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
9106
9107 if (relax_info->workaround_size != 0)
9108 {
9109 bfd_byte *p;
9110 unsigned int n;
9111 bfd_byte fill[4];
9112
9113 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, BA, fill);
9114 p = contents + input_section->size - relax_info->workaround_size;
9115 n = relax_info->workaround_size >> 2;
9116 while (n--)
9117 {
9118 memcpy (p, fill, 4);
9119 p += 4;
9120 }
9121 }
9122
9123 /* The idea is: Replace the last instruction on a page with a
9124 branch to a patch area. Put the insn there followed by a
9125 branch back to the next page. Complicated a little by
9126 needing to handle moved conditional branches, and by not
9127 wanting to touch data-in-text. */
9128
9129 start_addr = (input_section->output_section->vma
9130 + input_section->output_offset);
9131 end_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9132 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9133 for (addr = ((start_addr & -pagesize) + pagesize - 4);
9134 addr < end_addr;
9135 addr += pagesize)
9136 {
9137 bfd_vma offset = addr - start_addr;
9138 Elf_Internal_Rela *lo, *hi;
9139 bfd_boolean is_data;
9140 bfd_vma patch_off, patch_addr;
9141 unsigned int insn;
9142
9143 /* Do we have a data reloc at this offset? If so, leave
9144 the word alone. */
9145 is_data = FALSE;
9146 lo = relocs;
9147 hi = relend;
9148 rel = NULL;
9149 while (lo < hi)
9150 {
9151 rel = lo + (hi - lo) / 2;
9152 if (rel->r_offset < offset)
9153 lo = rel + 1;
9154 else if (rel->r_offset > offset + 3)
9155 hi = rel;
9156 else
9157 {
9158 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rel->r_info))
9159 {
9160 case R_PPC_ADDR32:
9161 case R_PPC_UADDR32:
9162 case R_PPC_REL32:
9163 case R_PPC_ADDR30:
9164 is_data = TRUE;
9165 break;
9166 default:
9167 break;
9168 }
9169 break;
9170 }
9171 }
9172 if (is_data)
9173 continue;
9174
9175 /* Some instructions can be left alone too. Unconditional
9176 branches, except for bcctr with BO=0x14 (bctr, bctrl),
9177 avoid the icache failure.
9178
9179 The problem occurs due to prefetch across a page boundary
9180 where stale instructions can be fetched from the next
9181 page, and the mechanism for flushing these bad
9182 instructions fails under certain circumstances. The
9183 unconditional branches:
9184 1) Branch: b, bl, ba, bla,
9185 2) Branch Conditional: bc, bca, bcl, bcla,
9186 3) Branch Conditional to Link Register: bclr, bclrl,
9187 where (2) and (3) have BO=0x14 making them unconditional,
9188 prevent the bad prefetch because the prefetch itself is
9189 affected by these instructions. This happens even if the
9190 instruction is not executed.
9191
9192 A bctr example:
9193 .
9194 . lis 9,new_page@ha
9195 . addi 9,9,new_page@l
9196 . mtctr 9
9197 . bctr
9198 . nop
9199 . nop
9200 . new_page:
9201 .
9202 The bctr is not predicted taken due to ctr not being
9203 ready, so prefetch continues on past the bctr into the
9204 new page which might have stale instructions. If they
9205 fail to be flushed, then they will be executed after the
9206 bctr executes. Either of the following modifications
9207 prevent the bad prefetch from happening in the first
9208 place:
9209 .
9210 . lis 9,new_page@ha lis 9,new_page@ha
9211 . addi 9,9,new_page@l addi 9,9,new_page@l
9212 . mtctr 9 mtctr 9
9213 . bctr bctr
9214 . nop b somewhere_else
9215 . b somewhere_else nop
9216 . new_page: new_page:
9217 . */
9218 insn = bfd_get_32 (input_bfd, contents + offset);
9219 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (18u << 26) /* b,bl,ba,bla */
9220 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc,bcl,bca,bcla*/
9221 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)) /* with BO=0x14 */
9222 || ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (19u << 26)
9223 && (insn & (0x3ff << 1)) == (16u << 1) /* bclr,bclrl */
9224 && (insn & (0x14 << 21)) == (0x14 << 21)))/* with BO=0x14 */
9225 continue;
9226
9227 patch_addr = (start_addr + input_section->size
9228 - relax_info->workaround_size);
9229 patch_addr = (patch_addr + 15) & -16;
9230 patch_off = patch_addr - start_addr;
9231 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, B + patch_off - offset, contents + offset);
9232
9233 if (rel != NULL
9234 && rel->r_offset >= offset
9235 && rel->r_offset < offset + 4)
9236 {
9237 asection *sreloc;
9238
9239 /* If the insn we are patching had a reloc, adjust the
9240 reloc r_offset so that the reloc applies to the moved
9241 location. This matters for -r and --emit-relocs. */
9242 if (rel + 1 != relend)
9243 {
9244 Elf_Internal_Rela tmp = *rel;
9245
9246 /* Keep the relocs sorted by r_offset. */
9247 memmove (rel, rel + 1, (relend - (rel + 1)) * sizeof (*rel));
9248 relend[-1] = tmp;
9249 }
9250 relend[-1].r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9251
9252 /* Adjust REL16 addends too. */
9253 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info))
9254 {
9255 case R_PPC_REL16:
9256 case R_PPC_REL16_LO:
9257 case R_PPC_REL16_HI:
9258 case R_PPC_REL16_HA:
9259 relend[-1].r_addend += patch_off - offset;
9260 break;
9261 default:
9262 break;
9263 }
9264
9265 /* If we are building a PIE or shared library with
9266 non-PIC objects, perhaps we had a dynamic reloc too?
9267 If so, the dynamic reloc must move with the insn. */
9268 sreloc = elf_section_data (input_section)->sreloc;
9269 if (sreloc != NULL)
9270 {
9271 Elf32_External_Rela *slo, *shi, *srelend;
9272 bfd_vma soffset;
9273
9274 slo = (Elf32_External_Rela *) sreloc->contents;
9275 shi = srelend = slo + sreloc->reloc_count;
9276 soffset = (offset + input_section->output_section->vma
9277 + input_section->output_offset);
9278 while (slo < shi)
9279 {
9280 Elf32_External_Rela *srel = slo + (shi - slo) / 2;
9281 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_in (output_bfd, (bfd_byte *) srel,
9282 &outrel);
9283 if (outrel.r_offset < soffset)
9284 slo = srel + 1;
9285 else if (outrel.r_offset > soffset + 3)
9286 shi = srel;
9287 else
9288 {
9289 if (srel + 1 != srelend)
9290 {
9291 memmove (srel, srel + 1,
9292 (srelend - (srel + 1)) * sizeof (*srel));
9293 srel = srelend - 1;
9294 }
9295 outrel.r_offset += patch_off - offset;
9296 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &outrel,
9297 (bfd_byte *) srel);
9298 break;
9299 }
9300 }
9301 }
9302 }
9303 else
9304 rel = NULL;
9305
9306 if ((insn & (0x3f << 26)) == (16u << 26) /* bc */
9307 && (insn & 2) == 0 /* relative */)
9308 {
9309 bfd_vma delta = ((insn & 0xfffc) ^ 0x8000) - 0x8000;
9310
9311 delta += offset - patch_off;
9312 if (bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9313 delta = 0;
9314 if (!bfd_link_relocatable (info) && rel != NULL)
9315 {
9316 enum elf_ppc_reloc_type r_type;
9317
9318 r_type = ELF32_R_TYPE (relend[-1].r_info);
9319 if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN)
9320 insn |= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9321 else if (r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9322 insn &= ~BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9323 else
9324 BFD_ASSERT (r_type == R_PPC_REL14);
9325
9326 if ((r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRTAKEN
9327 || r_type == R_PPC_REL14_BRNTAKEN)
9328 && delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000
9329 && (bfd_signed_vma) delta < 0)
9330 insn ^= BRANCH_PREDICT_BIT;
9331 }
9332 if (delta + 0x8000 < 0x10000)
9333 {
9334 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9335 (insn & ~0xfffc) | (delta & 0xfffc),
9336 contents + patch_off);
9337 patch_off += 4;
9338 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9339 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9340 contents + patch_off);
9341 patch_off += 4;
9342 }
9343 else
9344 {
9345 if (rel != NULL)
9346 {
9347 unsigned int r_sym = ELF32_R_SYM (relend[-1].r_info);
9348
9349 relend[-1].r_offset += 8;
9350 relend[-1].r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (r_sym, R_PPC_REL24);
9351 }
9352 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9353 (insn & ~0xfffc) | 8,
9354 contents + patch_off);
9355 patch_off += 4;
9356 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9357 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9358 contents + patch_off);
9359 patch_off += 4;
9360 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9361 B | ((delta - 8) & 0x3fffffc),
9362 contents + patch_off);
9363 patch_off += 4;
9364 }
9365 }
9366 else
9367 {
9368 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd, insn, contents + patch_off);
9369 patch_off += 4;
9370 bfd_put_32 (input_bfd,
9371 B | ((offset + 4 - patch_off) & 0x3fffffc),
9372 contents + patch_off);
9373 patch_off += 4;
9374 }
9375 BFD_ASSERT (patch_off <= input_section->size);
9376 relax_info->workaround_size = input_section->size - patch_off;
9377 }
9378 }
9379
9380 return ret;
9381 }
9382 \f
9383 /* Write out the PLT relocs and entries for H. */
9384
9385 static bfd_boolean
9386 write_global_sym_plt (struct elf_link_hash_entry *h, void *inf)
9387 {
9388 struct bfd_link_info *info = (struct bfd_link_info *) inf;
9389 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9390 struct plt_entry *ent;
9391 bfd_boolean doneone;
9392
9393 doneone = FALSE;
9394 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9395 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9396 {
9397 if (!doneone)
9398 {
9399 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9400 bfd_byte *loc;
9401 bfd_vma reloc_index;
9402 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9403 asection *relplt = htab->elf.srelplt;
9404
9405 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9406 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9407 || h->dynindx == -1)
9408 reloc_index = ent->plt.offset / 4;
9409 else
9410 {
9411 reloc_index = ((ent->plt.offset - htab->plt_initial_entry_size)
9412 / htab->plt_slot_size);
9413 if (reloc_index > PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES
9414 && htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9415 reloc_index -= (reloc_index - PLT_NUM_SINGLE_ENTRIES) / 2;
9416 }
9417
9418 /* This symbol has an entry in the procedure linkage table.
9419 Set it up. */
9420 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_VXWORKS
9421 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9422 && h->dynindx != -1)
9423 {
9424 bfd_vma got_offset;
9425 const bfd_vma *plt_entry;
9426
9427 /* The first three entries in .got.plt are reserved. */
9428 got_offset = (reloc_index + 3) * 4;
9429
9430 /* Use the right PLT. */
9431 plt_entry = bfd_link_pic (info) ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt_entry
9432 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt_entry;
9433
9434 /* Fill in the .plt on VxWorks. */
9435 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9436 {
9437 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9438 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_offset),
9439 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9440 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9441 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_offset),
9442 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9443 }
9444 else
9445 {
9446 bfd_vma got_loc = got_offset + SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9447
9448 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9449 plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_loc),
9450 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 0);
9451 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9452 plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_loc),
9453 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 4);
9454 }
9455
9456 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[2],
9457 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 8);
9458 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[3],
9459 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 12);
9460
9461 /* This instruction is an immediate load. The value loaded is
9462 the byte offset of the R_PPC_JMP_SLOT relocation from the
9463 start of the .rela.plt section. The value is stored in the
9464 low-order 16 bits of the load instruction. */
9465 /* NOTE: It appears that this is now an index rather than a
9466 prescaled offset. */
9467 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9468 plt_entry[4] | reloc_index,
9469 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 16);
9470 /* This instruction is a PC-relative branch whose target is
9471 the start of the PLT section. The address of this branch
9472 instruction is 20 bytes beyond the start of this PLT entry.
9473 The address is encoded in bits 6-29, inclusive. The value
9474 stored is right-shifted by two bits, permitting a 26-bit
9475 offset. */
9476 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd,
9477 (plt_entry[5]
9478 | (-(ent->plt.offset + 20) & 0x03fffffc)),
9479 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 20);
9480 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[6],
9481 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 24);
9482 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, plt_entry[7],
9483 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset + 28);
9484
9485 /* Fill in the GOT entry corresponding to this PLT slot with
9486 the address immediately after the "bctr" instruction
9487 in this PLT entry. */
9488 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, (plt->output_section->vma
9489 + plt->output_offset
9490 + ent->plt.offset + 16),
9491 htab->elf.sgotplt->contents + got_offset);
9492
9493 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9494 {
9495 /* Fill in a couple of entries in .rela.plt.unloaded. */
9496 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents
9497 + ((VXWORKS_PLTRESOLVE_RELOCS + reloc_index
9498 * VXWORKS_PLT_NON_JMP_SLOT_RELOCS)
9499 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9500
9501 /* Provide the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
9502 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9503 + plt->output_offset
9504 + ent->plt.offset + 2);
9505 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9506 R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
9507 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9508 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9509 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9510
9511 /* Provide the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
9512 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9513 + plt->output_offset
9514 + ent->plt.offset + 6);
9515 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx,
9516 R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
9517 rela.r_addend = got_offset;
9518 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9519 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9520
9521 /* Provide a relocation for the GOT entry corresponding to this
9522 PLT slot. Point it at the middle of the .plt entry. */
9523 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9524 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9525 + got_offset);
9526 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx,
9527 R_PPC_ADDR32);
9528 rela.r_addend = ent->plt.offset + 16;
9529 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9530 }
9531
9532 /* VxWorks uses non-standard semantics for R_PPC_JMP_SLOT.
9533 In particular, the offset for the relocation is not the
9534 address of the PLT entry for this function, as specified
9535 by the ABI. Instead, the offset is set to the address of
9536 the GOT slot for this function. See EABI 4.4.4.1. */
9537 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.sgotplt->output_section->vma
9538 + htab->elf.sgotplt->output_offset
9539 + got_offset);
9540 rela.r_addend = 0;
9541 }
9542 else
9543 {
9544 rela.r_addend = 0;
9545 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9546 || h->dynindx == -1)
9547 {
9548 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9549 {
9550 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9551 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9552 }
9553 else
9554 {
9555 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9556 relplt = bfd_link_pic (info) ? htab->relpltlocal : NULL;
9557 }
9558 if (h->def_regular
9559 && (h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defined
9560 || h->root.type == bfd_link_hash_defweak))
9561 rela.r_addend = SYM_VAL (h);
9562 }
9563
9564 if (relplt == NULL)
9565 {
9566 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9567 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, rela.r_addend, loc);
9568 }
9569 else
9570 {
9571 rela.r_offset = (plt->output_section->vma
9572 + plt->output_offset
9573 + ent->plt.offset);
9574
9575 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD
9576 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9577 || h->dynindx == -1)
9578 {
9579 /* We don't need to fill in the .plt. The ppc dynamic
9580 linker will fill it in. */
9581 }
9582 else
9583 {
9584 bfd_vma val = (htab->glink_pltresolve + ent->plt.offset
9585 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
9586 + htab->glink->output_offset);
9587 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val,
9588 plt->contents + ent->plt.offset);
9589 }
9590 }
9591 }
9592
9593 if (relplt != NULL)
9594 {
9595 /* Fill in the entry in the .rela.plt section. */
9596 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9597 || h->dynindx == -1)
9598 {
9599 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9600 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9601 else
9602 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9603 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9604 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9605 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9606 }
9607 else
9608 {
9609 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_JMP_SLOT);
9610 loc = relplt->contents + (reloc_index
9611 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9612 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && is_static_defined (h))
9613 htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9614 }
9615 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9616 }
9617 doneone = TRUE;
9618 }
9619
9620 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_NEW
9621 || !htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9622 || h->dynindx == -1)
9623 {
9624 unsigned char *p;
9625 asection *plt = htab->elf.splt;
9626
9627 if (!htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created
9628 || h->dynindx == -1)
9629 {
9630 if (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9631 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9632 else
9633 break;
9634 }
9635
9636 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9637 write_glink_stub (h, ent, plt, p, info);
9638
9639 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
9640 /* We only need one non-PIC glink stub. */
9641 break;
9642 }
9643 else
9644 break;
9645 }
9646 return TRUE;
9647 }
9648
9649 /* Finish up PLT handling. */
9650
9651 bfd_boolean
9652 ppc_finish_symbols (struct bfd_link_info *info)
9653 {
9654 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9655 bfd *ibfd;
9656
9657 if (!htab)
9658 return TRUE;
9659
9660 elf_link_hash_traverse (&htab->elf, write_global_sym_plt, info);
9661
9662 for (ibfd = info->input_bfds; ibfd != NULL; ibfd = ibfd->link.next)
9663 {
9664 bfd_vma *local_got, *end_local_got;
9665 struct plt_entry **local_plt, **lplt, **end_local_plt;
9666 Elf_Internal_Shdr *symtab_hdr;
9667 bfd_size_type locsymcount;
9668 Elf_Internal_Sym *local_syms = NULL;
9669 struct plt_entry *ent;
9670
9671 if (!is_ppc_elf (ibfd))
9672 continue;
9673
9674 local_got = elf_local_got_offsets (ibfd);
9675 if (!local_got)
9676 continue;
9677
9678 symtab_hdr = &elf_symtab_hdr (ibfd);
9679 locsymcount = symtab_hdr->sh_info;
9680 end_local_got = local_got + locsymcount;
9681 local_plt = (struct plt_entry **) end_local_got;
9682 end_local_plt = local_plt + locsymcount;
9683 for (lplt = local_plt; lplt < end_local_plt; ++lplt)
9684 for (ent = *lplt; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9685 {
9686 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9687 {
9688 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym;
9689 asection *sym_sec;
9690 asection *plt, *relplt;
9691 bfd_byte *loc;
9692 bfd_vma val;
9693 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9694 unsigned char *p;
9695
9696 if (!get_sym_h (NULL, &sym, &sym_sec, NULL, &local_syms,
9697 lplt - local_plt, ibfd))
9698 {
9699 if (local_syms != NULL
9700 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9701 free (local_syms);
9702 return FALSE;
9703 }
9704
9705 val = sym->st_value;
9706 if (sym_sec != NULL && sym_sec->output_section != NULL)
9707 val += sym_sec->output_offset + sym_sec->output_section->vma;
9708
9709 if (ELF_ST_TYPE (sym->st_info) == STT_GNU_IFUNC)
9710 {
9711 htab->local_ifunc_resolver = 1;
9712 plt = htab->elf.iplt;
9713 relplt = htab->elf.irelplt;
9714 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_IRELATIVE);
9715 }
9716 else
9717 {
9718 plt = htab->pltlocal;
9719 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
9720 {
9721 relplt = htab->relpltlocal;
9722 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (0, R_PPC_RELATIVE);
9723 }
9724 else
9725 {
9726 loc = plt->contents + ent->plt.offset;
9727 bfd_put_32 (info->output_bfd, val, loc);
9728 continue;
9729 }
9730 }
9731
9732 rela.r_offset = (ent->plt.offset
9733 + plt->output_offset
9734 + plt->output_section->vma);
9735 rela.r_addend = val;
9736 loc = relplt->contents + (relplt->reloc_count++
9737 * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela));
9738 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (info->output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9739
9740 p = (unsigned char *) htab->glink->contents + ent->glink_offset;
9741 write_glink_stub (NULL, ent, htab->elf.iplt, p, info);
9742 }
9743 }
9744
9745 if (local_syms != NULL
9746 && symtab_hdr->contents != (unsigned char *) local_syms)
9747 {
9748 if (!info->keep_memory)
9749 free (local_syms);
9750 else
9751 symtab_hdr->contents = (unsigned char *) local_syms;
9752 }
9753 }
9754 return TRUE;
9755 }
9756
9757 /* Finish up dynamic symbol handling. We set the contents of various
9758 dynamic sections here. */
9759
9760 static bfd_boolean
9761 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol (bfd *output_bfd,
9762 struct bfd_link_info *info,
9763 struct elf_link_hash_entry *h,
9764 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym)
9765 {
9766 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9767 struct plt_entry *ent;
9768
9769 #ifdef DEBUG
9770 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol called for %s",
9771 h->root.root.string);
9772 #endif
9773
9774 if (!h->def_regular
9775 || (h->type == STT_GNU_IFUNC && !bfd_link_pic (info)))
9776 for (ent = h->plt.plist; ent != NULL; ent = ent->next)
9777 if (ent->plt.offset != (bfd_vma) -1)
9778 {
9779 if (!h->def_regular)
9780 {
9781 /* Mark the symbol as undefined, rather than as
9782 defined in the .plt section. Leave the value if
9783 there were any relocations where pointer equality
9784 matters (this is a clue for the dynamic linker, to
9785 make function pointer comparisons work between an
9786 application and shared library), otherwise set it
9787 to zero. */
9788 sym->st_shndx = SHN_UNDEF;
9789 if (!h->pointer_equality_needed)
9790 sym->st_value = 0;
9791 else if (!h->ref_regular_nonweak)
9792 {
9793 /* This breaks function pointer comparisons, but
9794 that is better than breaking tests for a NULL
9795 function pointer. */
9796 sym->st_value = 0;
9797 }
9798 }
9799 else
9800 {
9801 /* Set the value of ifunc symbols in a non-pie
9802 executable to the glink entry. This is to avoid
9803 text relocations. We can't do this for ifunc in
9804 allocate_dynrelocs, as we do for normal dynamic
9805 function symbols with plt entries, because we need
9806 to keep the original value around for the ifunc
9807 relocation. */
9808 sym->st_shndx
9809 = (_bfd_elf_section_from_bfd_section
9810 (info->output_bfd, htab->glink->output_section));
9811 sym->st_value = (ent->glink_offset
9812 + htab->glink->output_offset
9813 + htab->glink->output_section->vma);
9814 }
9815 break;
9816 }
9817
9818 if (h->needs_copy)
9819 {
9820 asection *s;
9821 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
9822 bfd_byte *loc;
9823
9824 /* This symbols needs a copy reloc. Set it up. */
9825
9826 #ifdef DEBUG
9827 fprintf (stderr, ", copy");
9828 #endif
9829
9830 BFD_ASSERT (h->dynindx != -1);
9831
9832 if (ppc_elf_hash_entry (h)->has_sda_refs)
9833 s = htab->relsbss;
9834 else if (h->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sdynrelro)
9835 s = htab->elf.sreldynrelro;
9836 else
9837 s = htab->elf.srelbss;
9838 BFD_ASSERT (s != NULL);
9839
9840 rela.r_offset = SYM_VAL (h);
9841 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (h->dynindx, R_PPC_COPY);
9842 rela.r_addend = 0;
9843 loc = s->contents + s->reloc_count++ * sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
9844 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
9845 }
9846
9847 #ifdef DEBUG
9848 fprintf (stderr, "\n");
9849 #endif
9850
9851 return TRUE;
9852 }
9853 \f
9854 static enum elf_reloc_type_class
9855 ppc_elf_reloc_type_class (const struct bfd_link_info *info,
9856 const asection *rel_sec,
9857 const Elf_Internal_Rela *rela)
9858 {
9859 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9860
9861 if (rel_sec == htab->elf.irelplt)
9862 return reloc_class_ifunc;
9863
9864 switch (ELF32_R_TYPE (rela->r_info))
9865 {
9866 case R_PPC_RELATIVE:
9867 return reloc_class_relative;
9868 case R_PPC_JMP_SLOT:
9869 return reloc_class_plt;
9870 case R_PPC_COPY:
9871 return reloc_class_copy;
9872 default:
9873 return reloc_class_normal;
9874 }
9875 }
9876 \f
9877 /* Finish up the dynamic sections. */
9878
9879 static bfd_boolean
9880 ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections (bfd *output_bfd,
9881 struct bfd_link_info *info)
9882 {
9883 asection *sdyn;
9884 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab;
9885 bfd_vma got;
9886 bfd *dynobj;
9887 bfd_boolean ret = TRUE;
9888
9889 #ifdef DEBUG
9890 fprintf (stderr, "ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections called\n");
9891 #endif
9892
9893 htab = ppc_elf_hash_table (info);
9894 dynobj = htab->elf.dynobj;
9895 sdyn = bfd_get_linker_section (dynobj, ".dynamic");
9896
9897 got = 0;
9898 if (htab->elf.hgot != NULL)
9899 got = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
9900
9901 if (htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
9902 {
9903 Elf32_External_Dyn *dyncon, *dynconend;
9904
9905 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.splt != NULL && sdyn != NULL);
9906
9907 dyncon = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) sdyn->contents;
9908 dynconend = (Elf32_External_Dyn *) (sdyn->contents + sdyn->size);
9909 for (; dyncon < dynconend; dyncon++)
9910 {
9911 Elf_Internal_Dyn dyn;
9912 asection *s;
9913
9914 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_in (dynobj, dyncon, &dyn);
9915
9916 switch (dyn.d_tag)
9917 {
9918 case DT_PLTGOT:
9919 if (htab->is_vxworks)
9920 s = htab->elf.sgotplt;
9921 else
9922 s = htab->elf.splt;
9923 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9924 break;
9925
9926 case DT_PLTRELSZ:
9927 dyn.d_un.d_val = htab->elf.srelplt->size;
9928 break;
9929
9930 case DT_JMPREL:
9931 s = htab->elf.srelplt;
9932 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = s->output_section->vma + s->output_offset;
9933 break;
9934
9935 case DT_PPC_GOT:
9936 dyn.d_un.d_ptr = got;
9937 break;
9938
9939 case DT_TEXTREL:
9940 if (htab->local_ifunc_resolver)
9941 info->callbacks->einfo
9942 (_("%X%P: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9943 "functions will result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9944 else if (htab->maybe_local_ifunc_resolver)
9945 info->callbacks->einfo
9946 (_("%P: warning: text relocations and GNU indirect "
9947 "functions may result in a segfault at runtime\n"));
9948 continue;
9949
9950 default:
9951 if (htab->is_vxworks
9952 && elf_vxworks_finish_dynamic_entry (output_bfd, &dyn))
9953 break;
9954 continue;
9955 }
9956
9957 bfd_elf32_swap_dyn_out (output_bfd, &dyn, dyncon);
9958 }
9959 }
9960
9961 if (htab->elf.sgot != NULL
9962 && htab->elf.sgot->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
9963 {
9964 if (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgot
9965 || htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section == htab->elf.sgotplt)
9966 {
9967 unsigned char *p = htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->contents;
9968
9969 p += htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value;
9970 if (htab->plt_type == PLT_OLD)
9971 {
9972 /* Add a blrl instruction at _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_-4
9973 so that a function can easily find the address of
9974 _GLOBAL_OFFSET_TABLE_. */
9975 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value - 4
9976 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
9977 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, 0x4e800021, p - 4);
9978 }
9979
9980 if (sdyn != NULL)
9981 {
9982 bfd_vma val = sdyn->output_section->vma + sdyn->output_offset;
9983 BFD_ASSERT (htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.value
9984 < htab->elf.hgot->root.u.def.section->size);
9985 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, val, p);
9986 }
9987 }
9988 else
9989 {
9990 /* xgettext:c-format */
9991 _bfd_error_handler (_("%s not defined in linker created %pA"),
9992 htab->elf.hgot->root.root.string,
9993 (htab->elf.sgotplt != NULL
9994 ? htab->elf.sgotplt : htab->elf.sgot));
9995 bfd_set_error (bfd_error_bad_value);
9996 ret = FALSE;
9997 }
9998
9999 elf_section_data (htab->elf.sgot->output_section)->this_hdr.sh_entsize = 4;
10000 }
10001
10002 /* Fill in the first entry in the VxWorks procedure linkage table. */
10003 if (htab->is_vxworks
10004 && htab->elf.splt != NULL
10005 && htab->elf.splt->size != 0
10006 && htab->elf.splt->output_section != bfd_abs_section_ptr)
10007 {
10008 asection *splt = htab->elf.splt;
10009 /* Use the right PLT. */
10010 const bfd_vma *plt_entry = (bfd_link_pic (info)
10011 ? ppc_elf_vxworks_pic_plt0_entry
10012 : ppc_elf_vxworks_plt0_entry);
10013
10014 if (!bfd_link_pic (info))
10015 {
10016 bfd_vma got_value = SYM_VAL (htab->elf.hgot);
10017
10018 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0] | PPC_HA (got_value),
10019 splt->contents + 0);
10020 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1] | PPC_LO (got_value),
10021 splt->contents + 4);
10022 }
10023 else
10024 {
10025 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[0], splt->contents + 0);
10026 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[1], splt->contents + 4);
10027 }
10028 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[2], splt->contents + 8);
10029 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[3], splt->contents + 12);
10030 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[4], splt->contents + 16);
10031 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[5], splt->contents + 20);
10032 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[6], splt->contents + 24);
10033 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, plt_entry[7], splt->contents + 28);
10034
10035 if (! bfd_link_pic (info))
10036 {
10037 Elf_Internal_Rela rela;
10038 bfd_byte *loc;
10039
10040 loc = htab->srelplt2->contents;
10041
10042 /* Output the @ha relocation for the first instruction. */
10043 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10044 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10045 + 2);
10046 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10047 rela.r_addend = 0;
10048 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10049 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10050
10051 /* Output the @l relocation for the second instruction. */
10052 rela.r_offset = (htab->elf.splt->output_section->vma
10053 + htab->elf.splt->output_offset
10054 + 6);
10055 rela.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10056 rela.r_addend = 0;
10057 bfd_elf32_swap_reloca_out (output_bfd, &rela, loc);
10058 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10059
10060 /* Fix up the remaining relocations. They may have the wrong
10061 symbol index for _G_O_T_ or _P_L_T_ depending on the order
10062 in which symbols were output. */
10063 while (loc < htab->srelplt2->contents + htab->srelplt2->size)
10064 {
10065 Elf_Internal_Rela rel;
10066
10067 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10068 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_HA);
10069 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10070 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10071
10072 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10073 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hgot->indx, R_PPC_ADDR16_LO);
10074 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10075 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10076
10077 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_in (output_bfd, loc, &rel);
10078 rel.r_info = ELF32_R_INFO (htab->elf.hplt->indx, R_PPC_ADDR32);
10079 bfd_elf32_swap_reloc_out (output_bfd, &rel, loc);
10080 loc += sizeof (Elf32_External_Rela);
10081 }
10082 }
10083 }
10084
10085 if (htab->glink != NULL
10086 && htab->glink->contents != NULL
10087 && htab->elf.dynamic_sections_created)
10088 {
10089 unsigned char *p;
10090 unsigned char *endp;
10091 bfd_vma res0;
10092
10093 /*
10094 * PIC glink code is the following:
10095 *
10096 * # ith PLT code stub.
10097 * addis 11,30,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@ha
10098 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4-got)@l(11)
10099 * mtctr 11
10100 * bctr
10101 *
10102 * # A table of branches, one for each plt entry.
10103 * # The idea is that the plt call stub loads ctr and r11 with these
10104 * # addresses, so (r11 - res_0) gives the plt index * 4.
10105 * res_0: b PLTresolve
10106 * res_1: b PLTresolve
10107 * .
10108 * # Some number of entries towards the end can be nops
10109 * res_n_m3: nop
10110 * res_n_m2: nop
10111 * res_n_m1:
10112 *
10113 * PLTresolve:
10114 * addis 11,11,(1f-res_0)@ha
10115 * mflr 0
10116 * bcl 20,31,1f
10117 * 1: addi 11,11,(1b-res_0)@l
10118 * mflr 12
10119 * mtlr 0
10120 * sub 11,11,12 # r11 = index * 4
10121 * addis 12,12,(got+4-1b)@ha
10122 * lwz 0,(got+4-1b)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10123 * lwz 12,(got+8-1b)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10124 * mtctr 0
10125 * add 0,11,11
10126 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10127 * bctr
10128 *
10129 * Non-PIC glink code is a little simpler.
10130 *
10131 * # ith PLT code stub.
10132 * lis 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@ha
10133 * lwz 11,(plt+(i-1)*4)@l(11)
10134 * mtctr 11
10135 * bctr
10136 *
10137 * The branch table is the same, then comes
10138 *
10139 * PLTresolve:
10140 * lis 12,(got+4)@ha
10141 * addis 11,11,(-res_0)@ha
10142 * lwz 0,(got+4)@l(12) # got[1] address of dl_runtime_resolve
10143 * addi 11,11,(-res_0)@l # r11 = index * 4
10144 * mtctr 0
10145 * add 0,11,11
10146 * lwz 12,(got+8)@l(12) # got[2] contains the map address
10147 * add 11,0,11 # r11 = index * 12 = reloc offset.
10148 * bctr
10149 */
10150
10151 /* Build the branch table, one for each plt entry (less one),
10152 and perhaps some padding. */
10153 p = htab->glink->contents;
10154 p += htab->glink_pltresolve;
10155 endp = htab->glink->contents;
10156 endp += htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10157 while (p < endp - (htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? 0 : 8 * 4))
10158 {
10159 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B + endp - p, p);
10160 p += 4;
10161 }
10162 while (p < endp)
10163 {
10164 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, NOP, p);
10165 p += 4;
10166 }
10167
10168 res0 = (htab->glink_pltresolve
10169 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10170 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10171
10172 if (htab->params->ppc476_workaround)
10173 {
10174 /* Ensure that a call stub at the end of a page doesn't
10175 result in prefetch over the end of the page into the
10176 glink branch table. */
10177 bfd_vma pagesize = (bfd_vma) 1 << htab->params->pagesize_p2;
10178 bfd_vma page_addr;
10179 bfd_vma glink_start = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10180 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10181
10182 for (page_addr = res0 & -pagesize;
10183 page_addr > glink_start;
10184 page_addr -= pagesize)
10185 {
10186 /* We have a plt call stub that may need fixing. */
10187 bfd_byte *loc;
10188 unsigned int insn;
10189
10190 loc = htab->glink->contents + page_addr - 4 - glink_start;
10191 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc);
10192 if (insn == BCTR)
10193 {
10194 /* By alignment, we know that there must be at least
10195 one other call stub before this one. */
10196 insn = bfd_get_32 (output_bfd, loc - 16);
10197 if (insn == BCTR)
10198 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-16 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10199 else
10200 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, B | (-20 & 0x3fffffc), loc);
10201 }
10202 }
10203 }
10204
10205 /* Last comes the PLTresolve stub. */
10206 endp = p + GLINK_PLTRESOLVE;
10207 if (bfd_link_pic (info))
10208 {
10209 bfd_vma bcl;
10210
10211 bcl = (htab->glink->size - GLINK_PLTRESOLVE + 3*4
10212 + htab->glink->output_section->vma
10213 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10214
10215 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (bcl - res0), p);
10216 p += 4;
10217 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_0, p);
10218 p += 4;
10219 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCL_20_31, p);
10220 p += 4;
10221 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (bcl - res0), p);
10222 p += 4;
10223 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MFLR_12, p);
10224 p += 4;
10225 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTLR_0, p);
10226 p += 4;
10227 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, SUB_11_11_12, p);
10228 p += 4;
10229 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_12_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10230 p += 4;
10231 if (PPC_HA (got + 4 - bcl) == PPC_HA (got + 8 - bcl))
10232 {
10233 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10234 p += 4;
10235 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8 - bcl), p);
10236 p += 4;
10237 }
10238 else
10239 {
10240 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4 - bcl), p);
10241 p += 4;
10242 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10243 p += 4;
10244 }
10245 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10246 p += 4;
10247 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10248 }
10249 else
10250 {
10251 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LIS_12 + PPC_HA (got + 4), p);
10252 p += 4;
10253 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDIS_11_11 + PPC_HA (-res0), p);
10254 p += 4;
10255 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10256 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10257 else
10258 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZU_0_12 + PPC_LO (got + 4), p);
10259 p += 4;
10260 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADDI_11_11 + PPC_LO (-res0), p);
10261 p += 4;
10262 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, MTCTR_0, p);
10263 p += 4;
10264 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_0_11_11, p);
10265 p += 4;
10266 if (PPC_HA (got + 4) == PPC_HA (got + 8))
10267 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + PPC_LO (got + 8), p);
10268 else
10269 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, LWZ_12_12 + 4, p);
10270 }
10271 p += 4;
10272 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, ADD_11_0_11, p);
10273 p += 4;
10274 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd, BCTR, p);
10275 p += 4;
10276 while (p < endp)
10277 {
10278 bfd_put_32 (output_bfd,
10279 htab->params->ppc476_workaround ? BA : NOP, p);
10280 p += 4;
10281 }
10282 BFD_ASSERT (p == endp);
10283 }
10284
10285 if (htab->glink_eh_frame != NULL
10286 && htab->glink_eh_frame->contents != NULL)
10287 {
10288 unsigned char *p = htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10289 bfd_vma val;
10290
10291 p += sizeof (glink_eh_frame_cie);
10292 /* FDE length. */
10293 p += 4;
10294 /* CIE pointer. */
10295 p += 4;
10296 /* Offset to .glink. */
10297 val = (htab->glink->output_section->vma
10298 + htab->glink->output_offset);
10299 val -= (htab->glink_eh_frame->output_section->vma
10300 + htab->glink_eh_frame->output_offset);
10301 val -= p - htab->glink_eh_frame->contents;
10302 bfd_put_32 (htab->elf.dynobj, val, p);
10303
10304 if (htab->glink_eh_frame->sec_info_type == SEC_INFO_TYPE_EH_FRAME
10305 && !_bfd_elf_write_section_eh_frame (output_bfd, info,
10306 htab->glink_eh_frame,
10307 htab->glink_eh_frame->contents))
10308 return FALSE;
10309 }
10310
10311 return ret;
10312 }
10313 \f
10314 #define TARGET_LITTLE_SYM powerpc_elf32_le_vec
10315 #define TARGET_LITTLE_NAME "elf32-powerpcle"
10316 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vec
10317 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc"
10318 #define ELF_ARCH bfd_arch_powerpc
10319 #define ELF_TARGET_ID PPC32_ELF_DATA
10320 #define ELF_MACHINE_CODE EM_PPC
10321 #define ELF_MAXPAGESIZE 0x10000
10322 #define ELF_COMMONPAGESIZE 0x1000
10323 #define ELF_RELROPAGESIZE ELF_MAXPAGESIZE
10324 #define elf_info_to_howto ppc_elf_info_to_howto
10325
10326 #ifdef EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10327 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT1 EM_CYGNUS_POWERPC
10328 #endif
10329
10330 #ifdef EM_PPC_OLD
10331 #define ELF_MACHINE_ALT2 EM_PPC_OLD
10332 #endif
10333
10334 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 1
10335 #define elf_backend_want_dynrelro 1
10336 #define elf_backend_can_gc_sections 1
10337 #define elf_backend_can_refcount 1
10338 #define elf_backend_rela_normal 1
10339 #define elf_backend_caches_rawsize 1
10340
10341 #define bfd_elf32_mkobject ppc_elf_mkobject
10342 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_merge_private_bfd_data ppc_elf_merge_private_bfd_data
10343 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_relax_section ppc_elf_relax_section
10344 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_type_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_type_lookup
10345 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_reloc_name_lookup ppc_elf_reloc_name_lookup
10346 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_set_private_flags ppc_elf_set_private_flags
10347 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create
10348 #define bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab ppc_elf_get_synthetic_symtab
10349
10350 #define elf_backend_object_p ppc_elf_object_p
10351 #define elf_backend_gc_mark_hook ppc_elf_gc_mark_hook
10352 #define elf_backend_section_from_shdr ppc_elf_section_from_shdr
10353 #define elf_backend_relocate_section ppc_elf_relocate_section
10354 #define elf_backend_create_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_create_dynamic_sections
10355 #define elf_backend_check_relocs ppc_elf_check_relocs
10356 #define elf_backend_relocs_compatible _bfd_elf_relocs_compatible
10357 #define elf_backend_copy_indirect_symbol ppc_elf_copy_indirect_symbol
10358 #define elf_backend_adjust_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_adjust_dynamic_symbol
10359 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook
10360 #define elf_backend_size_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_size_dynamic_sections
10361 #define elf_backend_hash_symbol ppc_elf_hash_symbol
10362 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_symbol ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_symbol
10363 #define elf_backend_finish_dynamic_sections ppc_elf_finish_dynamic_sections
10364 #define elf_backend_fake_sections ppc_elf_fake_sections
10365 #define elf_backend_additional_program_headers ppc_elf_additional_program_headers
10366 #define elf_backend_modify_segment_map ppc_elf_modify_segment_map
10367 #define elf_backend_grok_prstatus ppc_elf_grok_prstatus
10368 #define elf_backend_grok_psinfo ppc_elf_grok_psinfo
10369 #define elf_backend_write_core_note ppc_elf_write_core_note
10370 #define elf_backend_reloc_type_class ppc_elf_reloc_type_class
10371 #define elf_backend_begin_write_processing ppc_elf_begin_write_processing
10372 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing ppc_elf_final_write_processing
10373 #define elf_backend_write_section ppc_elf_write_section
10374 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr
10375 #define elf_backend_plt_sym_val ppc_elf_plt_sym_val
10376 #define elf_backend_action_discarded ppc_elf_action_discarded
10377 #define elf_backend_init_index_section _bfd_elf_init_1_index_section
10378 #define elf_backend_lookup_section_flags_hook ppc_elf_lookup_section_flags
10379
10380 #include "elf32-target.h"
10381
10382 /* FreeBSD Target */
10383
10384 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10385 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10386
10387 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10388 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_fbsd_vec
10389 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10390 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-freebsd"
10391
10392 #undef ELF_OSABI
10393 #define ELF_OSABI ELFOSABI_FREEBSD
10394
10395 #undef elf32_bed
10396 #define elf32_bed elf32_powerpc_fbsd_bed
10397
10398 #include "elf32-target.h"
10399
10400 /* VxWorks Target */
10401
10402 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_SYM
10403 #undef TARGET_LITTLE_NAME
10404
10405 #undef TARGET_BIG_SYM
10406 #define TARGET_BIG_SYM powerpc_elf32_vxworks_vec
10407 #undef TARGET_BIG_NAME
10408 #define TARGET_BIG_NAME "elf32-powerpc-vxworks"
10409
10410 #undef ELF_OSABI
10411
10412 /* VxWorks uses the elf default section flags for .plt. */
10413 static const struct bfd_elf_special_section *
10414 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr (bfd *abfd, asection *sec)
10415 {
10416 if (sec->name == NULL)
10417 return NULL;
10418
10419 if (strcmp (sec->name, ".plt") == 0)
10420 return _bfd_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10421
10422 return ppc_elf_get_sec_type_attr (abfd, sec);
10423 }
10424
10425 /* Like ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create, but overrides
10426 appropriately for VxWorks. */
10427 static struct bfd_link_hash_table *
10428 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create (bfd *abfd)
10429 {
10430 struct bfd_link_hash_table *ret;
10431
10432 ret = ppc_elf_link_hash_table_create (abfd);
10433 if (ret)
10434 {
10435 struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *htab
10436 = (struct ppc_elf_link_hash_table *)ret;
10437 htab->is_vxworks = 1;
10438 htab->plt_type = PLT_VXWORKS;
10439 htab->plt_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10440 htab->plt_slot_size = VXWORKS_PLT_ENTRY_SIZE;
10441 htab->plt_initial_entry_size = VXWORKS_PLT_INITIAL_ENTRY_SIZE;
10442 }
10443 return ret;
10444 }
10445
10446 /* Tweak magic VxWorks symbols as they are loaded. */
10447 static bfd_boolean
10448 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (bfd *abfd,
10449 struct bfd_link_info *info,
10450 Elf_Internal_Sym *sym,
10451 const char **namep,
10452 flagword *flagsp,
10453 asection **secp,
10454 bfd_vma *valp)
10455 {
10456 if (!elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp,
10457 valp))
10458 return FALSE;
10459
10460 return ppc_elf_add_symbol_hook (abfd, info, sym, namep, flagsp, secp, valp);
10461 }
10462
10463 static bfd_boolean
10464 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (bfd *abfd)
10465 {
10466 ppc_final_write_processing (abfd);
10467 return elf_vxworks_final_write_processing (abfd);
10468 }
10469
10470 /* On VxWorks, we emit relocations against _PROCEDURE_LINKAGE_TABLE_, so
10471 define it. */
10472 #undef elf_backend_want_plt_sym
10473 #define elf_backend_want_plt_sym 1
10474 #undef elf_backend_want_got_plt
10475 #define elf_backend_want_got_plt 1
10476 #undef elf_backend_got_symbol_offset
10477 #define elf_backend_got_symbol_offset 0
10478 #undef elf_backend_plt_not_loaded
10479 #define elf_backend_plt_not_loaded 0
10480 #undef elf_backend_plt_readonly
10481 #define elf_backend_plt_readonly 1
10482 #undef elf_backend_got_header_size
10483 #define elf_backend_got_header_size 12
10484 #undef elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt
10485 #define elf_backend_dtrel_excludes_plt 1
10486
10487 #undef bfd_elf32_get_synthetic_symtab
10488
10489 #undef bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create
10490 #define bfd_elf32_bfd_link_hash_table_create \
10491 ppc_elf_vxworks_link_hash_table_create
10492 #undef elf_backend_add_symbol_hook
10493 #define elf_backend_add_symbol_hook \
10494 ppc_elf_vxworks_add_symbol_hook
10495 #undef elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook
10496 #define elf_backend_link_output_symbol_hook \
10497 elf_vxworks_link_output_symbol_hook
10498 #undef elf_backend_final_write_processing
10499 #define elf_backend_final_write_processing \
10500 ppc_elf_vxworks_final_write_processing
10501 #undef elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr
10502 #define elf_backend_get_sec_type_attr \
10503 ppc_elf_vxworks_get_sec_type_attr
10504 #undef elf_backend_emit_relocs
10505 #define elf_backend_emit_relocs \
10506 elf_vxworks_emit_relocs
10507
10508 #undef elf32_bed
10509 #define elf32_bed ppc_elf_vxworks_bed
10510 #undef elf_backend_post_process_headers
10511
10512 #include "elf32-target.h"
This page took 0.473462 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.